PR2589, ld vs. ld.so
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
250d07de 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
250d07de 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
250d07de 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
279d901e
L
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
5fa222e4
AM
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
cd6d6c15 1369@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1371
e6e2dfbd
AM
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1374
e6e2dfbd
AM
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1385
1386@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1388
1389@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1391
1392@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1394
6aa29e7b
JJ
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1405
e6e2dfbd
AM
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1410
cd6d6c15
NC
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1417
1418@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1420
6aa29e7b 1421@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1422@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1428
68b00778
L
1429@item report-relative-reloc
1430Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1431Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1432
47acac12
L
1433@item separate-code
1434@itemx noseparate-code
1435Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1436specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1437be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1438code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1439
496afd17
L
1440@item unique-symbol
1441@itemx nounique-symbol
1442Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1443".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1444is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1445
e6e2dfbd
AM
1446@item shstk
1447Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1448to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1449Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1450
04c3a755 1451@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1452Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1453Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1454@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1455
8ee10e86
AM
1456@item start-stop-gc
1457@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1458@cindex start-stop-gc
1459When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1460section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1461input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1462@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1463@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1464linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1465sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1466were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1467definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1468object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1469linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1470@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1471treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1472
cae64165
RM
1473@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1474@cindex visibility
1475@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1476Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1477@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1478Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1479@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1480start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1481compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1482recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1483programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1484between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1485
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486@item text
1487@itemx notext
1488@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1489Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1490or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1491report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1492
97a232d7
NC
1493@item undefs
1494Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1495either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1496This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1497
b0ab0693 1498@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1499@item x86-64-v2
1500@item x86-64-v3
1501@itemx x86-64-v4
1502Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1503@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1504@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1505@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1506@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1507Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1508
cd6d6c15
NC
1509@end table
1510
ece2d90e 1511Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1512
1513@kindex -(
1514@cindex groups of archives
1515@item -( @var{archives} -)
1516@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1517The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1518either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1519
1520The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1521references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1522the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1523archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1524object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1525would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1526they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1527resolved.
1528
1529Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1530it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1531more archives.
1532
69da35b5
NC
1533@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1534@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1535@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1536@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1537Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1538recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1539and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1540the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1541behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1542so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1543restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1544
4a43e768
AM
1545@kindex --as-needed
1546@kindex --no-as-needed
1547@item --as-needed
1548@itemx --no-as-needed
1549This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1550on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1551the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1552on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1553needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1554emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1555non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1556the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1557non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1558Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1559the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1560needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1561from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1562
6418520e
NC
1563Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1564an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1565@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1566@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1567
e56f61be
L
1568@kindex --add-needed
1569@kindex --no-add-needed
1570@item --add-needed
1571@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1572These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1573their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1574options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1575and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1576
252b5132
RH
1577@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1578@item -assert @var{keyword}
1579This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1580
1581@kindex -Bdynamic
1582@kindex -dy
1583@kindex -call_shared
1584@item -Bdynamic
1585@itemx -dy
1586@itemx -call_shared
1587Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1588for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1589default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1590for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1591multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1592@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1593
a1ab1d2a
UD
1594@kindex -Bgroup
1595@item -Bgroup
1596Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1597section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1598object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1599@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1600only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1601
252b5132
RH
1602@kindex -Bstatic
1603@kindex -dn
1604@kindex -non_shared
1605@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1606@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1607@itemx -dn
1608@itemx -non_shared
1609@itemx -static
1610Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1611platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1612variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1613may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1614library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1615option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1616option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1617shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1618references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1619libraries.
252b5132
RH
1620
1621@kindex -Bsymbolic
1622@item -Bsymbolic
1623When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1624definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1625for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1626within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1627platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1628
40b36307
L
1629@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1630@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1631When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1632symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1633This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1634libraries.
40b36307 1635
cf893b0e
FS
1636@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1637@item -Bno-symbolic
1638This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1639@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1640
55255dae
L
1641@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1642@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1643Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1644typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1645global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1646within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1647to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1648in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1649which support shared libraries.
1650
1651The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1652scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1653
40b36307
L
1654@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1655@item --dynamic-list-data
1656Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1657
1658@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1659@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1660Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1661is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1662
0b8a70d9
L
1663@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1664@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1665Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1666
252b5132
RH
1667@kindex --check-sections
1668@kindex --no-check-sections
1669@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1670@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1671Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1672been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1673perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1674suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1675allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1676restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1677Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1678force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1679option.
252b5132 1680
ddbb8a31
NC
1681@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1682@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1683@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1684@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1685This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1686by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1687command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1688output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1689input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1690specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1691follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1692behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1693
1694This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1695libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1696mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1697their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1698required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1699the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1700dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1701symbols.
1702
252b5132
RH
1703@cindex cross reference table
1704@kindex --cref
1705@item --cref
1706Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1707generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1708Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1709
1710The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1711easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1712sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1713symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1714definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1715where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1716symbol are listed.
252b5132 1717
5dba6f05
NA
1718@cindex ctf variables
1719@kindex --ctf-variables
1720@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1721@item --ctf-variables
1722@item --no-ctf-variables
1723The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1724types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1725table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1726conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1727usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1728@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1729The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1730
1731@cindex ctf type sharing
1732@kindex --ctf-share-types
1733@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1734Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1735
1736@table @samp
1737@item share-unconflicted
1738Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1739where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1740translation unit. This is the default.
1741
1742@item share-duplicated
1743Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1744dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1745dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1746always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1747larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1748large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1749consumer at runtime.
1750@end table
1751
4818e05f
AM
1752@cindex common allocation
1753@kindex --no-define-common
1754@item --no-define-common
1755This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1756The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1757@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1758
1759The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1760the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1761of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1762forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1763Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1764from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1765This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1766and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1767duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1768paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1769
7bdf4127
AB
1770@cindex group allocation in linker script
1771@cindex section groups
1772@cindex COMDAT
1773@kindex --force-group-allocation
1774@item --force-group-allocation
1775This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1776normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1777default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1778change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1779command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1780effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1781
252b5132 1782@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1783@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1784@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1785Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1786address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1787times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1788limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1789context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1790symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1791constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1792using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1793@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1794equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1795
54874444
AB
1796The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1797in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1798symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1799placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1800the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1801consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1802@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1803you are trying to achieve.
1804
252b5132 1805@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1806@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1807@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1808@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1809@itemx --no-demangle
1810These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1811and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1812present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1813underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1814mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1815different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1816to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1817demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1818is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1819
1820@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1821@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1822@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1823@item -I@var{file}
1824@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1825Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1826generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1827linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1828doing.
1829
9b8b325a
RF
1830@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1831@item --no-dynamic-linker
1832When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1833linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1834executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1835entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1836
a70f34c0
NC
1837@kindex --embedded-relocs
1838@item --embedded-relocs
1839This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1840that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1841is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1842targets.
1843
3f0a5f17
ME
1844@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1845@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1846Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1847in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1848
7ce691ae 1849@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1850@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1851@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1852@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1853Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1854with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1855
252b5132
RH
1856@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1857@item --force-exe-suffix
1858Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1859
1860If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1861@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1862the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1863option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1864Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1865it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1866
1867@kindex --gc-sections
1868@kindex --no-gc-sections
1869@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1870@item --gc-sections
1871@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1872Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1873targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1874performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1875@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1876collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1877implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1878
d5465ba2
AM
1879@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1880examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1881symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1882command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1883referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1884libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1885referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1886the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1887relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1888@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1889
ac69cbc6 1890This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1891@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1892specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1893@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1894command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1895
99fabbc9
JL
1896As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1897@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1898
c17d87de
NC
1899@kindex --print-gc-sections
1900@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1901@cindex garbage collection
1902@item --print-gc-sections
1903@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1904List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1905printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1906collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1907default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1908be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1909line.
1910
22185505 1911@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1912@cindex garbage collection
1913@item --gc-keep-exported
1914When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1915collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1916default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1917executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1918collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1919Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1920it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1921ELF format targets.
1922
30824704
RM
1923@kindex --print-output-format
1924@cindex output format
1925@item --print-output-format
1926Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1927other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1928in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1929
3604cb1f
TG
1930@kindex --print-memory-usage
1931@cindex memory usage
1932@item --print-memory-usage
1933Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1934the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1935quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1936headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1937parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1938
1939@smallexample
1940Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1941 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1942 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1943@end smallexample
1944
252b5132
RH
1945@cindex help
1946@cindex usage
1947@kindex --help
1948@item --help
1949Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1950
ea20a7da
CC
1951@kindex --target-help
1952@item --target-help
a094d01f 1953Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1954
2509a395
SL
1955@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1956@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1957Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1958@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1959@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1960
1961Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1962written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1963inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1964file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1965@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1966output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1967@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1968
1969@smallexample
1970 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1971 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1972 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1973 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1974 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1975 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1976 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1977 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1978 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1979 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1980@end smallexample
1981
1982It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1983
1984If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1985operation.
252b5132
RH
1986
1987@cindex memory usage
1988@kindex --no-keep-memory
1989@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1990@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1991symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1992instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1993necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1994while linking a large executable.
1995
1996@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1997@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1998@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1999@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2000@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2001Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2002is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2003The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2004behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2005libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2006
97a232d7
NC
2007The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2008
aa713662
L
2009@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2010@kindex -z muldefs
2011@item --allow-multiple-definition
2012@itemx -z muldefs
2013Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2014report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2015first definition will be used.
2016
b79e8c78 2017@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2018@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2019@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2020@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2021Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2022This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2023determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2024shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2025how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2026
903249d7
NC
2027The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2028referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2029an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2030a shared library.
2031
2032The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2033libraries specified at link time are that:
2034
2035@itemize @bullet
2036@item
2037A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2038that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2039resolvable at load time.
2040@item
2041There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2042symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2043
2044The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2045select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2046architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2047appropriate memset function.
2048@end itemize
b79e8c78 2049
23ae20f5
NC
2050@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2051@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2052If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2053@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2054only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2055libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2056``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2057undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2058will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2059might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2060error message will be displayed.
2061
2062The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2063switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2064
31941635
L
2065@kindex --no-undefined-version
2066@item --no-undefined-version
2067Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2068it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2069will be issued instead.
2070
3e3b46e5
PB
2071@kindex --default-symver
2072@item --default-symver
2073Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2074exported symbols.
2075
2076@kindex --default-imported-symver
2077@item --default-imported-symver
2078Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2079imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2080
252b5132
RH
2081@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2082@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2083Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2084files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2085been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2086This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2087errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2088have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2089inappropriate.
2090
fe7929ce
AM
2091@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2092@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2093Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2094library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2095
252b5132
RH
2096@kindex --no-whole-archive
2097@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2098Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2099archive files.
2100
2101@cindex output file after errors
2102@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2103@item --noinhibit-exec
2104Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2105Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2106errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2107when it issues any error whatsoever.
2108
0a9c1c8e
CD
2109@kindex -nostdlib
2110@item -nostdlib
2111Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2112command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2113(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2114
252b5132 2115@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2116@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2117@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2118@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2119file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2120@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2121object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2122object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2123should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2124usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2125name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2126list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2127command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2128this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2129@end ifclear
2130
76359541
TP
2131@kindex --out-implib
2132@item --out-implib @var{file}
2133Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2134the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2135library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2136may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2137behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2138step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2139the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2140
36af4a4e
JJ
2141@kindex -pie
2142@kindex --pic-executable
2143@item -pie
2144@itemx --pic-executable
2145@cindex position independent executables
2146Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2147ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2148libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2149address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2150normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2151defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2152
252b5132
RH
2153@kindex -qmagic
2154@item -qmagic
2155This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2156
2157@kindex -Qy
2158@item -Qy
2159This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2160
2161@kindex --relax
2162@cindex synthesizing linker
2163@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2164@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2165@item --relax
28d5f677 2166@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2167An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2168@ifset GENERIC
2169This option is only supported on a few targets.
2170@end ifset
2171@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2172@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2173@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2174@ifset XTENSA
2175@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2176@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2177@ifset M68HC11
2178@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2179@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2180@ifset NIOSII
2181@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2182@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2183@ifset POWERPC
2184@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2185@end ifset
252b5132 2186
ccd9fae5 2187On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2188global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2189addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2190synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2191instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2192
2193On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2194debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2195@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2196This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2197family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2198@end ifset
2199
ccd9fae5
NC
2200On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2201@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2202
ccd9fae5
NC
2203On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2204and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2205
252b5132
RH
2206@cindex retaining specified symbols
2207@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2208@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2209@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2210@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2211Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2212discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2213symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2214@ifset GENERIC
2215(such as VxWorks)
2216@end ifset
2217where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2218run-time memory.
2219
2220@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2221or symbols needed for relocations.
2222
2223You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2224line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2225
2226@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2227@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2228@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2229@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2230Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2231linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2232arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2233them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2234
2235The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2236are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2237description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2238in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2239have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2240
2241If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2242contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2243is defined.
252b5132 2244
ff5dcc92 2245The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2246SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2247@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2248runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2249options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2250gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2251file systems.
252b5132 2252
ff5dcc92 2253For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2254followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2255the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2256@end ifset
2257
2258@ifset GENERIC
2259@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2260@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2261@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2262When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2263happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2264of the input files.
2265
2266When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2267non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2268shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2269explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2270specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2271@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2272either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2273appearing multiple times.
2274
e680a6b6
NC
2275The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2276directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2277containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2278and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
227964-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2280
2281The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2282@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2283supported.
2284
28c309a2
NC
2285This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2286that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2287is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2288runtime linker would do.
2289
252b5132 2290The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2291libraries:
d8e4137b 2292
252b5132
RH
2293@enumerate
2294@item
ff5dcc92 2295Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2296@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2297Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2298between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2299specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2300used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2301at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2302by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2303the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2304@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2305On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2306@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2307environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2308@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2309On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2310directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2311@item
a1b8d843 2312For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2313variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2314@item
ec4eb78a
L
2315For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2316@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2317libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2318@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2319@item
d8e4137b
NC
2320For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2321exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2322to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2323defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2324configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2325@item
2326For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2327the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2328header file.
2329@item
364d7729
AM
2330Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2331linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2332by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2333@item
2334The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2335@item
2336Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2337@item
2338Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2339linker script.
252b5132
RH
2340@end enumerate
2341
6418520e
NC
2342Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2343the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2344is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2345library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2346@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2347directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2348this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2349@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2350of the first.
2351
252b5132
RH
2352If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2353warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2354
252b5132
RH
2355@end ifset
2356
2357@kindex -shared
2358@kindex -Bshareable
2359@item -shared
2360@itemx -Bshareable
2361@cindex shared libraries
2362Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2363and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2364shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2365undefined symbols in the link.
2366
252b5132 2367@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2368@item --sort-common
2369@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2370@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2371This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2372ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2373sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2374eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2375between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2376specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2377
2509a395
SL
2378@kindex --sort-section=name
2379@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2380This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2381patterns in the linker script.
2382
2509a395
SL
2383@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2384@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2385This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2386patterns in the linker script.
2387
a70f34c0
NC
2388@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2389@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2390This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2391.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2392post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2393
252b5132 2394@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2395@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2396Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2397each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2398size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2399
2400@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2401@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2402Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2403output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2404This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2405certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2406cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2407that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2408support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2409input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2410more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2411many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2412
2413@kindex --stats
2414@item --stats
2415Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2416as execution time and memory usage.
2417
2509a395 2418@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2419@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2420Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2421configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2422that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2423
a70f34c0
NC
2424@kindex --task-link
2425@item --task-link
2426This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2427file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2428
252b5132
RH
2429@kindex --traditional-format
2430@cindex traditional format
2431@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2432For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2433the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2434use the traditional format instead.
2435
2436@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2437For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2438symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2439full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2440@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2441trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2442combine duplicate entries.
2443
2509a395
SL
2444@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2445@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2446Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2447address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2448times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2449line.
2450@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2451for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2452@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2453should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2454sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2455
2509a395
SL
2456@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2457@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2458@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2459@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2460@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2461@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2462@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2463Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2464@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2465
2509a395
SL
2466@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2467@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2468@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2469When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2470byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2471
9d5777a3
RM
2472@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2473@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2474@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2475When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2476the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2477text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2478
0d705e9f
AM
2479@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2480@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2481@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2482When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2483model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2484
560e09e9
NC
2485@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2486@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2487Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2488values for @samp{method}:
2489
2490@table @samp
2491@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2492Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2493
2494@item report-all
da8bce14 2495Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2496
2497@item ignore-in-object-files
2498Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2499ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2500
2501@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2502Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2503ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2504when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2505libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2506command line.
2507@end table
2508
2509The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2510by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2511
2512Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2513unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2514can change this to a warning.
2515
1715a13c
L
2516@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2517@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2518@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2519@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2520Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2521supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2522the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2523argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2524
2525@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2526@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2527@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2528Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2529used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2530about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2531is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2532see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2533use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2534symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2535@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2536
7ce691ae 2537@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2538@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2539@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2540@item --warn-common
2541Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2542a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2543but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2544you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2545Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2546warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2547
2548There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2549
2550@table @samp
2551@item int i = 1;
2552A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2553file.
2554
2555@item extern int i;
2556An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2557There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2558variable somewhere.
2559
2560@item int i;
2561A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2562variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2563The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2564single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2565size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2566a definition of the same variable.
2567@end table
2568
2569The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2570Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2571just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2572encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2573a common symbol.
2574
2575@enumerate
2576@item
2577Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2578definition for the symbol.
2579@smallexample
2580@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2581 overridden by definition
2582@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2583@end smallexample
2584
2585@item
2586Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2587the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2588except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2589@smallexample
2590@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2591 overriding common
2592@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2593@end smallexample
2594
2595@item
2596Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2597@smallexample
2598@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2599 of `@var{symbol}'
2600@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2601@end smallexample
2602
2603@item
2604Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2605@smallexample
2606@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2607 overridden by larger common
2608@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2609@end smallexample
2610
2611@item
2612Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2613the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2614encountered in a different order.
2615@smallexample
2616@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2617 overriding smaller common
2618@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2619@end smallexample
2620@end enumerate
2621
2622@kindex --warn-constructors
2623@item --warn-constructors
2624Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2625object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2626detect the use of global constructors.
2627
2628@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2629@item --warn-multiple-gp
2630Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2631This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2632Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2633section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2634of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2635base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2636base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2637bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2638large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2639values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2640option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2641
2642@kindex --warn-once
2643@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2644@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2645@item --warn-once
2646Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2647which refers to it.
2648
2649@kindex --warn-section-align
2650@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2651@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2652@item --warn-section-align
2653Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2654alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2655The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2656is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2657the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2658
a6dbf402
L
2659@kindex --warn-textrel
2660@item --warn-textrel
2661Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2662or shared object.
8fdd7217 2663
a0c402a5
L
2664@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2665@item --warn-alternate-em
2666Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2667
560e09e9
NC
2668@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2669@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2670If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2671@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2672This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2673
2674@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2675@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2676This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2677it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2678
252b5132
RH
2679@kindex --whole-archive
2680@cindex including an entire archive
2681@item --whole-archive
2682For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2683@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2684in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2685files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2686library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2687library. This option may be used more than once.
2688
7ec229ce 2689Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2690about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2691Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2692list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2693your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2694
2509a395
SL
2695@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2696@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2697Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2698@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2699undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2700@var{symbol}.
2701
2702This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2703wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2704wishes to call the system function, it should call
2705@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2706
2707Here is a trivial example:
2708
2709@smallexample
2710void *
cc2f008e 2711__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2712@{
cc2f008e 2713 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2714 return __real_malloc (c);
2715@}
2716@end smallexample
2717
ff5dcc92 2718If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2719all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2720instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2721call the real @code{malloc} function.
2722
2723You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2724links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2725you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2726file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2727call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2728
4ea904ed
SH
2729Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2730internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2731@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2732@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2733
2734@smallexample
2735int
2736f (void)
2737@{
2738 return 123;
2739@}
2740
2741int
2742g (void)
2743@{
2744 return f();
2745@}
2746@end smallexample
2747
6aa29e7b 2748@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2749@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2750@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2751@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2752Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2753(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2754section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2755
e41b3a13
JJ
2756@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2757@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2758Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2759generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2760if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2761
6c1439be
L
2762@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2763@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2764@item --enable-new-dtags
2765@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2766This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2767systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2768@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2769and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2770If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2771created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2772those options are only available for ELF systems.
2773
2d643429 2774@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2775@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2776Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2777close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2778time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2779increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2780value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2781
fdc90cb4
JJ
2782@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2783@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2784Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2785@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2786new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2787the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2788hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2789but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2790
0ce398f1
L
2791@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2792@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2793@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2794@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2795@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2796@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2797@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2798@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2799On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2800compressed using zlib.
2801
2802@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2803sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2804DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2805instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2806also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2807sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2808
2809The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2810@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2811
2812Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2813sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2814for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2815uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2816
2817The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2818involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2819default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2820@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2821
35835446
JR
2822@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2823@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2824This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2825linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2826for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2827about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2828
4f9c04f7 2829Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 28301021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2831run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2832has been used.
2833
2834The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2835enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2836
c0065db7
RM
2837@kindex --build-id
2838@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2839@item --build-id
2840@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2841Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2842or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2843unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2844@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2845@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2846@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2847the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2848string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2849@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2850is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2851
2852The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2853that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2854unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2855to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2856file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2857string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2858
2859Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2860@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2861@end table
2862
0285c67d
NC
2863@c man end
2864
36f63dca 2865@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2866
0285c67d
NC
2867@c man begin OPTIONS
2868
ff5dcc92 2869The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2870the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2871normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2872use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2873@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2874like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2875symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2876object file).
2877
2878In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2879support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2880PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2881values by either a space or an equals sign.
2882
ff5dcc92 2883@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2884
2885@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2886@item --add-stdcall-alias
2887If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2888as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2889[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2890
2891@kindex --base-file
2892@item --base-file @var{file}
2893Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2894addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2895@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2896[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2897
2898@kindex --dll
2899@item --dll
2900Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2901@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2902file.
bb10df36 2903[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2904
88183869
DK
2905@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2906@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2907@item --enable-long-section-names
2908@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2909The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2910the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2911for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2912fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2913to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2914allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2915disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2916generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2917as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2918with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2919GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2920information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2921option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2922section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2923when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2924image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2925[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2926
252b5132
RH
2927@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2928@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2929@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2930@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2931If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2932do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2933only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2934resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2935undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2936@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2937to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2938warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2939import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2940to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2941feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2942@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2943mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2944[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2945
522f09cd
KT
2946@kindex --leading-underscore
2947@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2948@item --leading-underscore
2949@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2950For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2951in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2952disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2953
252b5132
RH
2954@cindex DLLs, creating
2955@kindex --export-all-symbols
2956@item --export-all-symbols
2957If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2958be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2959otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2960explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2961attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2962option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2963@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2964@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2965exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2966re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2967such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2968@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2969@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2970Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2971not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2972extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2973(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2974These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2975@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2976@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2977@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2978@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2979[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2980
2981@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2982@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2983Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2984exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2985[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2986
2927aaca
NC
2987@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2988@item --exclude-all-symbols
2989Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2990[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2991
252b5132
RH
2992@kindex --file-alignment
2993@item --file-alignment
2994Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2995file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2996512.
bb10df36 2997[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2998
2999@cindex heap size
3000@kindex --heap
3001@item --heap @var{reserve}
3002@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3003Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3004to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3005committed.
bb10df36 3006[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3007
3008@cindex image base
3009@kindex --image-base
3010@item --image-base @var{value}
3011Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3012the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3013is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3014your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3015other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3016for dlls.
bb10df36 3017[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3018
3019@kindex --kill-at
3020@item --kill-at
3021If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3022symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3023[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3024
26d2d8a2
BF
3025@kindex --large-address-aware
3026@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3027If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3028header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3029greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3030or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3031section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3032[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3033
f69a2f97
NC
3034@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3035@item --disable-large-address-aware
3036Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3037This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3038driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3039addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3040[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3041
252b5132
RH
3042@kindex --major-image-version
3043@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3044Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3045[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3046
3047@kindex --major-os-version
3048@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3049Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3050[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3051
3052@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3053@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3054Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3055[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3056
3057@kindex --minor-image-version
3058@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3059Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3060[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3061
3062@kindex --minor-os-version
3063@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3064Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3065[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3066
3067@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3068@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3069Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3070[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3071
3072@cindex DEF files, creating
3073@cindex DLLs, creating
3074@kindex --output-def
3075@item --output-def @var{file}
3076The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3077file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3078(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3079library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3080automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3081[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3082
b044cda1 3083@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3084@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3085@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3086@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3087Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3088@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3089By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3090for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3091execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3092[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3093
3094@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3095@item --disable-auto-image-base
3096Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3097user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3098default.
bb10df36 3099[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3100
3101@cindex DLLs, linking to
3102@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3103@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3104When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3105search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3106@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3107between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3108uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3109@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3110[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3111
3112@kindex --enable-auto-import
3113@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3114Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3115DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3116mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3117[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3118
3119The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3120feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3121
3122Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3123of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3124PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3125
e2a83dd0
NC
3126Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3127data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3128placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3129around a problem with consts that is described here:
3130http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3131
4d8907ac
DS
3132Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3133see this message:
0d888aac 3134
ece2d90e 3135"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3136documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3137
ece2d90e
NC
3138This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3139ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3140allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3141fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3142constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3143multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3144this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3145of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3146the warning, and exit.
3147
3148There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3149data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3150
2fa9fc65
NC
3151One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3152of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3153this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3154
c0065db7
RM
3155A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3156that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3157there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3158a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3159
3160@example
3161extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3162extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3163 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3164@end example
3165
3166or
3167
3168@example
3169extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3170extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3171 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3172@end example
3173
c0065db7 3174For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3175is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3176
3177@example
3178extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3179extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3180 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3181@end example
3182
c406afaf
NC
3183or
3184
3185@example
3186extern long long extern_ll;
3187extern_ll -->
3188 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3189@end example
3190
2fa9fc65 3191A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3192'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3193@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3194requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3195building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3196merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3197between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3198constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3199
3200Original:
3201@example
3202--foo.h
3203extern int arr[];
3204--foo.c
3205#include "foo.h"
3206void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3207 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3208@}
3209@end example
3210
3211Solution 1:
3212@example
3213--foo.h
3214extern int arr[];
3215--foo.c
3216#include "foo.h"
3217void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3218 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3219 volatile int *parr = arr;
3220 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3221@}
3222@end example
3223
3224Solution 2:
3225@example
3226--foo.h
3227/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3228#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3229 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3230#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3231#else
3232#define FOO_IMPORT
3233#endif
3234extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3235--foo.c
3236#include "foo.h"
3237void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3238 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3239@}
3240@end example
3241
c0065db7 3242A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3243library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3244for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3245functions).
b044cda1
CW
3246
3247@kindex --disable-auto-import
3248@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3249Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3250@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3251[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3252
2fa9fc65
NC
3253@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3254@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3255If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3256that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3257a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3258environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3259[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3260
3261@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3262@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3263Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3264[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3265
b044cda1
CW
3266@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3267@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3268Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3269[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3270
252b5132
RH
3271@kindex --section-alignment
3272@item --section-alignment
3273Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3274addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3275[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3276
3277@cindex stack size
3278@kindex --stack
3279@item --stack @var{reserve}
3280@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3281Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3282to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3283committed.
bb10df36 3284[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3285
3286@kindex --subsystem
3287@item --subsystem @var{which}
3288@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3289@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3290Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3291legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3292@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3293the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3294@var{which}.
bb10df36 3295[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3296
2f563b51
DK
3297The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3298of the PE file header:
3299[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3300
2d5c3743
NC
3301@kindex --high-entropy-va
3302@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3303@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3304Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3305(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3306
dc9bd8c9
HD
3307This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3308@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3309
2f563b51
DK
3310@kindex --dynamicbase
3311@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3312@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3313The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3314randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3315Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3316can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3317This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3318
3319@kindex --forceinteg
3320@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3321@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3322Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3323default.
2f563b51
DK
3324
3325@kindex --nxcompat
3326@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3327@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3328The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3329This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3330targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3331
3332@kindex --no-isolation
3333@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3334@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3335Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3336This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3337
3338@kindex --no-seh
3339@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3340@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3341The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3342this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3343
3344@kindex --no-bind
3345@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3346@itemx --disable-no-bind
3347Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3348
3349@kindex --wdmdriver
3350@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3351@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3352The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3353by default.
9d5777a3 3354
2f563b51
DK
3355@kindex --tsaware
3356@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3357@itemx --disable-tsaware
3358The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3359default.
2f563b51 3360
0cb112f7
CF
3361@kindex --insert-timestamp
3362@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3363@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3364Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3365as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3366other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3367will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3368same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3369can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3370that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3371identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3372
3373@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3374@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3375@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3376Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3377is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3378This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3379@end table
3380
0285c67d
NC
3381@c man end
3382
ac145307
BS
3383@ifset C6X
3384@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3385
3386@c man begin OPTIONS
3387
3388The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3389libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3390all executables use an index of 0.
3391
3392@table @gcctabopt
3393
3394@kindex --dsbt-size
3395@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3396This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3397or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3398entries.
3399
3400@kindex --dsbt-index
3401@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3402This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3403to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3404executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3405@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3406
fbd9ad90
PB
3407@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3408The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3409exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3410
ac145307
BS
3411@end table
3412
3413@c man end
3414@end ifset
3415
b8891f8d
AJ
3416@ifset CSKY
3417@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3418
3419@c man begin OPTIONS
3420
3421@table @gcctabopt
3422
3423@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3424@item --branch-stub
3425This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3426sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3427usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3428can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3429the compiler or assembler.
3430
3431@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3432@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3433This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3434It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3435be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3436stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3437sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3438@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3439linker should choose suitable defaults.
3440
3441@end table
3442
3443@c man end
3444@end ifset
3445
93fd0973
SC
3446@ifset M68HC11
3447@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3448
3449@c man begin OPTIONS
3450
3451The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3452memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3453
3454@table @gcctabopt
3455
3456@kindex --no-trampoline
3457@item --no-trampoline
3458This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3459is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3460instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3461
3462@kindex --bank-window
3463@item --bank-window @var{name}
3464This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3465the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3466The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3467paging and addresses within the memory window.
3468
3469@end table
3470
3471@c man end
3472@end ifset
3473
7fb9f789
NC
3474@ifset M68K
3475@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3476
3477@c man begin OPTIONS
3478
3479The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3480when linking for 68K targets.
3481
3482@table @gcctabopt
3483
3484@kindex --got
3485@item --got=@var{type}
3486This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3487@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3488@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3489Info entry for @file{ld}.
3490
3491@end table
3492
3493@c man end
3494@end ifset
3495
833794fc
MR
3496@ifset MIPS
3497@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3498
3499@c man begin OPTIONS
3500
3501The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3502generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3503linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3504
3505@table @gcctabopt
3506
3507@kindex --insn32
3508@item --insn32
3509@kindex --no-insn32
3510@itemx --no-insn32
3511These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3512generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3513or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
351432-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3515used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3516possible.
3517
8b10b0b3
MR
3518@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3519@item --ignore-branch-isa
3520@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3521@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3522These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3523transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3524accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3525is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3526instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3527equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3528calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3529a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3530an error.
3531
3734320d
MF
3532@kindex --compact-branches
3533@item --compact-branches
3534@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3535@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3536These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3537in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3538
833794fc
MR
3539@end table
3540
3541@c man end
3542@end ifset
3543
fa1477dc
SC
3544
3545@ifset PDP11
3546@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3547
3548@c man begin OPTIONS
3549
3550For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3551produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3552for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3553targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3554defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3555here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3556
3557@table @gcctabopt
3558
3559@kindex -N
3560@item -N
3561@kindex --omagic
3562@itemx --omagic
3563
3564Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3565indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3566shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3567writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3568the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3569programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3570from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3571
3572@kindex -n
3573@item -n
3574@kindex --nmagic
3575@itemx --nmagic
3576
3577Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3578indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3579be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3580file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3581byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3582a @emph{pure executable} format.
3583
3584@kindex -z
3585@item -z
3586@kindex --imagic
3587@itemx --imagic
3588
3589Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3590indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3591data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3592instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3593larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3594to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3595shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3596option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3597and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3598this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3599executable} format.
3600
3601@kindex --no-omagic
3602@item --no-omagic
3603
3604Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3605
3606@end table
3607
3608@c man end
3609@end ifset
3610
252b5132
RH
3611@ifset UsesEnvVars
3612@node Environment
3613@section Environment Variables
3614
0285c67d
NC
3615@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3616
560e09e9 3617You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3618@ifclear SingleFormat
3619@code{GNUTARGET},
3620@end ifclear
3621@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3622
36f63dca 3623@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3624@kindex GNUTARGET
3625@cindex default input format
3626@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3627use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3628of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3629@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3630of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3631attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3632this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3633there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3634object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3635BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3636in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3637@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3638
3639@kindex LDEMULATION
3640@cindex default emulation
3641@cindex emulation, default
3642@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3643@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3644behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3645available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3646the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3647variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3648linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3649
3650@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3651@cindex demangling, default
3652Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3653@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3654default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3655a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3656may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3657options.
3658
0285c67d
NC
3659@c man end
3660@end ifset
3661
252b5132
RH
3662@node Scripts
3663@chapter Linker Scripts
3664
3665@cindex scripts
3666@cindex linker scripts
3667@cindex command files
3668Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3669written in the linker command language.
3670
3671The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3672the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3673the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3674more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3675direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3676described below.
3677
3678The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3679yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3680linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3681to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3682such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3683
3684You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3685line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3686default linker script.
3687
3688You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3689to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3690Linker Scripts}.
3691
3692@menu
3693* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3694* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3695* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3696* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3697* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3698* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3699* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3700* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3701* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3702* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3703* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3704@end menu
3705
3706@node Basic Script Concepts
3707@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3708@cindex linker script concepts
3709We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3710describe the linker script language.
3711
3712The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3713file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3714@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3715The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3716purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3717among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3718section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3719in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3720
3721Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3722also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3723contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3724the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3725A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3726area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3727loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3728which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3729of debugging information.
3730
3731Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3732first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3733the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3734@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3735section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3736same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3737is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3738(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3739based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3740RAM address would be the VMA.
3741
3742You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3743program with the @samp{-h} option.
3744
3745Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3746@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3747has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3748information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3749will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3750static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3751referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3752
3753You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3754program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3755option.
3756
3757@node Script Format
3758@section Linker Script Format
3759@cindex linker script format
3760Linker scripts are text files.
3761
3762You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3763either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3764symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3765generally ignored.
3766
3767Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3768If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3769otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3770double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3771file name.
3772
3773You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3774@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3775to whitespace.
3776
3777@node Simple Example
3778@section Simple Linker Script Example
3779@cindex linker script example
3780@cindex example of linker script
3781Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3782
3783The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3784@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3785memory layout of the output file.
3786
3787The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3788describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3789code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3790@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3791Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3792your input files.
3793
3794For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37950x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3796linker script which will do that:
3797@smallexample
3798SECTIONS
3799@{
3800 . = 0x10000;
3801 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3802 . = 0x8000000;
3803 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3804 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3805@}
3806@end smallexample
3807
3808You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3809followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3810descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3811
252b5132
RH
3812The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3813sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3814counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3815other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3816current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3817incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3818@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3819
3820The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3821required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3822after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3823which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3824wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3825means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3826
3827Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3828@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3829@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3830
3831The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3832the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3833at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3834output section, the value of the location counter will be
3835@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3836effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3837immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3838
3839The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3840alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3841example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3842sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3843may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3844sections.
3845
3846That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3847
3848@node Simple Commands
3849@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3850@cindex linker script simple commands
3851In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3852
3853@menu
3854* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3855* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3856@ifclear SingleFormat
3857* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3858@end ifclear
3859
4a93e180 3860* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3861* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3862@end menu
3863
3864@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3865@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3866@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3867@cindex start of execution
3868@cindex first instruction
3869@cindex entry point
3870The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3871point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3872entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3873@smallexample
3874ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3875@end smallexample
3876
3877There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3878entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3879stopping when one of them succeeds:
3880@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3881@item
252b5132 3882the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3883@item
252b5132 3884the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3885@item
a094d01f 3886the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3887targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3888check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3889@item
252b5132 3890the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3891@item
252b5132
RH
3892The address @code{0}.
3893@end itemize
3894
3895@node File Commands
36f63dca 3896@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3897@cindex linker script file commands
3898Several linker script commands deal with files.
3899
3900@table @code
3901@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3902@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3903@cindex including a linker script
3904Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3905be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3906with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
390710 levels deep.
3908
4006703d
NS
3909You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3910@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3911
252b5132
RH
3912@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3913@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3914@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3915@cindex input files in linker scripts
3916@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3917@cindex linker script input object files
3918The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3919in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3920
3921For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3922a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3923then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3924
3925In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3926script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3927
e3f2db7f
AO
3928In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3929with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3930located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3931for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3932@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3933filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3934@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3935
3936If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3937the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3938found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3939not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3940path.
252b5132 3941
ff5dcc92 3942If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3943name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3944@samp{-l}.
3945
3946When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3947files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3948script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3949
3950@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3951@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3952@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3953@cindex grouping input files
3954The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3955files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3956new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3957in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3958
b717d30e
JJ
3959@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3960@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3961@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3962This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3963commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3964as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3965with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3966when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3967@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3968and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3969setting afterwards.
3970
252b5132
RH
3971@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3972@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3973@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3974The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3975@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3976@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3977Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3978precedence.
3979
3980You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3981output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3982
3983@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3984@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3985@cindex library search path in linker script
3986@cindex archive search path in linker script
3987@cindex search path in linker script
3988The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3989@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3990@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3991on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3992are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3993the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3994
3995@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3996@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3997@cindex first input file
3998The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3999that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4000though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4001when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4002first file.
4003@end table
4004
4005@ifclear SingleFormat
4006@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4007@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4008A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4009
4010@table @code
4011@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4012@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4013@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4014@cindex output file format in linker script
4015The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4016output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4017exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4018(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4019line option takes precedence.
4020
4021You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4022formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4023This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4024desired endianness.
4025
4026If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4027will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4028output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4029used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4030
4031For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4032command:
4033@smallexample
4034OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4035@end smallexample
4036This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4037@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4038option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4039format.
4040
4041@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4042@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4043@cindex input file format in linker script
4044The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4045files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4046This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4047(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4048is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4049command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4050@end table
4051@end ifclear
4052
4a93e180
NC
4053@node REGION_ALIAS
4054@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4055@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4056@cindex region alias
4057@cindex region names
4058
4059Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4060@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4061
4062@smallexample
4063REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4064@end smallexample
4065
4066The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4067memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4068to memory regions. An example follows.
4069
4070Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4071memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4072that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4073non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4074access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4075read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4076sections:
4077
4078@itemize @bullet
4079@item
4080@code{.text} program code;
4081@item
4082@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4083@item
4084@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4085@item
4086@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4087@end itemize
4088
4089The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4090part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4091output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4092systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4093@code{C}:
4094@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4095@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4096@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4097@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4098@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4099@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4100@end multitable
4101The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4102loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4103the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4104the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4105
4106The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4107includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4108memory layout:
4109@smallexample
4110INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4111
4112SECTIONS
4113 @{
4114 .text :
4115 @{
4116 *(.text)
4117 @} > REGION_TEXT
4118 .rodata :
4119 @{
4120 *(.rodata)
4121 rodata_end = .;
4122 @} > REGION_RODATA
4123 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4124 @{
4125 data_start = .;
4126 *(.data)
4127 @} > REGION_DATA
4128 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4129 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4130 .bss :
4131 @{
4132 *(.bss)
4133 @} > REGION_BSS
4134 @}
4135@end smallexample
4136
4137Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4138regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4139variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4140@table @code
4141@item A
4142Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4143@smallexample
4144MEMORY
4145 @{
4146 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4147 @}
4148
4149REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4150REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4151REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4152REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4153@end smallexample
4154@item B
4155Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4156into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4157@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4158@smallexample
4159MEMORY
4160 @{
4161 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4162 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4163 @}
4164
4165REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4166REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4167REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4168REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4169@end smallexample
4170@item C
4171Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4172@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4173initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4174system start into the @code{RAM}.
4175@smallexample
4176MEMORY
4177 @{
4178 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4179 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4180 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4181 @}
4182
4183REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4184REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4185REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4186REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4187@end smallexample
4188@end table
4189
4190It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4191@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4192necessary:
4193@smallexample
4194#include <string.h>
4195
4196extern char data_start [];
4197extern char data_size [];
4198extern char data_load_start [];
4199
4200void copy_data(void)
4201@{
4202 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4203 @{
4204 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4205 @}
4206@}
4207@end smallexample
4208
252b5132 4209@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4210@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4211There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4212
4213@table @code
4214@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4215@kindex ASSERT
4216@cindex assertion in linker script
4217Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4218with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4219
fd1c4238
NC
4220Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4221take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4222inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4223for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4224symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4225
4226@smallexample
4227 .stack :
4228 @{
4229 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4230 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4231 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4232 @}
4233@end smallexample
4234
4235will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4236PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4237can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4238
4239@smallexample
4240 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4241 .stack :
4242 @{
4243 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4244 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4245 @}
4246@end smallexample
4247
4248will work.
4249
252b5132
RH
4250@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4251@kindex EXTERN
4252@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4253Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4254symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4255modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4256each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4257command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4258
4259@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4260@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4261@cindex common allocation in linker script
4262This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4263to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4264output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4265
4818e05f
AM
4266@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4267@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4268@cindex common allocation in linker script
4269This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4270command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4271to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4272
7bdf4127
AB
4273@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4274@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4275@cindex group allocation in linker script
4276@cindex section groups
4277@cindex COMDAT
4278This command has the same effect as the
4279@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4280@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4281and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4282specified (@samp{-r}).
4283
53d25da6
AM
4284@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4285@kindex INSERT
4286@cindex insert user script into default script
4287This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4288augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4289inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4290@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4291default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4292sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4293linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4294insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4295linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4296default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4297of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4298to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4299is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4300
4301@smallexample
4302SECTIONS
4303@{
4304 OVERLAY :
4305 @{
4306 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4307 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4308 @}
4309@}
4310INSERT AFTER .text;
4311@end smallexample
4312
252b5132
RH
4313@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4314@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4315@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4316This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4317references among certain output sections.
4318
4319In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4320using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4321will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4322errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4323a function defined in the other section.
4324
4325The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4326@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4327an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4328@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4329names.
4330
cdf96953
MF
4331@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4332@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4333@cindex cross references
4334This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4335references to one section from a list of other sections.
4336
4337The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4338output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4339a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4340there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4341must never call back.
4342
4343The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4344The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4345If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4346the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4347status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4348names, not input section names.
4349
252b5132
RH
4350@ifclear SingleFormat
4351@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4352@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4353@cindex machine architecture
4354@cindex architecture
4355Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4356of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4357architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4358the @samp{-f} option.
4359@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4360
4361@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4362@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4363This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4364@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4365in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4366@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4367@end table
4368
4369@node Assignments
4370@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4371@cindex assignment in scripts
4372@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4373@cindex variables, defining
4374You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4375the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4376
4377@menu
4378* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4379* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4380* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4381* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4382* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4383@end menu
4384
4385@node Simple Assignments
4386@subsection Simple Assignments
4387
4388You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4389
4390@table @code
4391@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4392@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4393@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4394@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4395@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4396@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4397@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4398@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4399@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4400@end table
4401
4402The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4403@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4404defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4405
4406The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4407may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4408
4409The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4410
4411Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4412
4413You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4414statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4415section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4416
4417The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4418expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4419
4420Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4421assignments may be used:
4422
4423@smallexample
4424floating_point = 0;
4425SECTIONS
4426@{
4427 .text :
4428 @{
4429 *(.text)
4430 _etext = .;
4431 @}
156e34dd 4432 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4433 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4434@}
4435@end smallexample
4436@noindent
4437In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4438zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4439the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4440defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4441upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4442
eb8476a6
MR
4443@node HIDDEN
4444@subsection HIDDEN
4445@cindex HIDDEN
4446For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4447exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4448
4449Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4450@code{HIDDEN}:
4451
4452@smallexample
4453HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4454SECTIONS
4455@{
4456 .text :
4457 @{
4458 *(.text)
4459 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4460 @}
4461 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4462 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4463@}
4464@end smallexample
4465@noindent
4466In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4467
252b5132
RH
4468@node PROVIDE
4469@subsection PROVIDE
4470@cindex PROVIDE
4471In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4472only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4473the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4474@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4475@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4476@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4477@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4478@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4479
4480Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4481@smallexample
4482SECTIONS
4483@{
4484 .text :
4485 @{
4486 *(.text)
4487 _etext = .;
4488 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4489 @}
4490@}
4491@end smallexample
4492
4493In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4494underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4495on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4496underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4497If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4498linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4499
b0daac83
NC
4500Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4501defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4502that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4503when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4504@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4505
7af8e998
L
4506@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4507@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4508@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4509Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4510hidden and won't be exported.
4511
73ae6183
NC
4512@node Source Code Reference
4513@subsection Source Code Reference
4514
4515Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4516intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4517a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4518symbol that does not have a value.
4519
4520Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4521transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4522stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4523prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4524mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4525of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4526variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4527linker script variable might be referred to as:
4528
4529@smallexample
4530 extern int foo;
4531@end smallexample
4532
4533But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4534
4535@smallexample
4536 _foo = 1000;
4537@end smallexample
4538
4539In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4540transformation has taken place.
4541
4542When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4543things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4544in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4545second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4546table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4547contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4548value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4549
4550@smallexample
4551 int foo = 1000;
4552@end smallexample
4553
10bf6894 4554creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4555holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4556number 1000 is initially stored.
4557
4558When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4559first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4560memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4561So:
4562
4563@smallexample
4564 foo = 1;
4565@end smallexample
4566
4567looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4568associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4569address. Whereas:
4570
4571@smallexample
4572 int * a = & foo;
4573@end smallexample
4574
10bf6894 4575looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4576and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4577the variable @samp{a}.
4578
4579Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4580the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4581an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4582
4583@smallexample
4584 foo = 1000;
4585@end smallexample
4586
4587creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4588the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4589address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4590linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4591access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4592
4593Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4594you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4595use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4596section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4597linker script contains these declarations:
4598
4599@smallexample
4600@group
4601 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4602 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4603 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4604@end group
4605@end smallexample
4606
4607Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4608
4609@smallexample
4610@group
4611 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4612
73ae6183
NC
4613 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4614@end group
4615@end smallexample
4616
4617Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4618Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4619arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4620
4621@smallexample
4622@group
4623 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4624
4625 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4626@end group
4627@end smallexample
4628
4629Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4630operators.
73ae6183 4631
252b5132 4632@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4633@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4634@kindex SECTIONS
4635The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4636into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4637
4638The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4639@smallexample
4640SECTIONS
4641@{
4642 @var{sections-command}
4643 @var{sections-command}
4644 @dots{}
4645@}
4646@end smallexample
4647
4648Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4649
4650@itemize @bullet
4651@item
4652an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4653@item
4654a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4655@item
4656an output section description
4657@item
4658an overlay description
4659@end itemize
4660
4661The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4662@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4663those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4664understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4665the layout of the output file.
4666
4667Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4668below.
4669
4670If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4671linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4672section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4673input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4674example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4675in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4676
4677@menu
4678* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4679* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4680* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4681* Input Section:: Input section description
4682* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4683* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4684* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4685* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4686* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4687@end menu
4688
4689@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4690@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4691The full description of an output section looks like this:
4692@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4693@group
7e7d5768 4694@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4695 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4696 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4697 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4698 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4699 @{
4700 @var{output-section-command}
4701 @var{output-section-command}
4702 @dots{}
abc9061b 4703 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4704@end group
4705@end smallexample
4706
4707Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4708
4709The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4710name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4711The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4712the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4713The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4714
4715Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4716
4717@itemize @bullet
4718@item
4719a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4720@item
4721an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4722@item
4723data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4724@item
4725a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4726@end itemize
4727
4728@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4729@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4730@cindex name, section
4731@cindex section name
4732The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4733meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4734support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4735must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4736example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4737output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4738names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4739quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4740characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4741commas must be quoted.
4742
4743The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4744Discarding}.
4745
4746@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4747@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4748@cindex address, section
4749@cindex section address
4750The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4751address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4752is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4753
4754If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4755section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4756to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4757alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4758contained within the output section.
4759
4760The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4761
4762@itemize @bullet
4763@item
4764If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4765is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4766in that region.
4767
4768@item
4769If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4770regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4771section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4772be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4773
4774@item
4775If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4776the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4777counter.
4778@end itemize
4779
4780@noindent
4781For example:
4782
252b5132
RH
4783@smallexample
4784.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4785@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4786
252b5132
RH
4787@noindent
4788and
ea5cae92 4789
252b5132
RH
4790@smallexample
4791.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4792@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4793
252b5132
RH
4794@noindent
4795are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4796@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4797counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4798counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4799input sections.
252b5132
RH
4800
4801The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4802For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4803so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4804do something like this:
4805@smallexample
4806.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4807@end smallexample
4808@noindent
4809This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4810aligned upward to the specified value.
4811
4812Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4813location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4814sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4815
4816@node Input Section
36f63dca 4817@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4818@cindex input sections
4819@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4820The most common output section command is an input section description.
4821
4822The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4823You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4824in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4825map the input files into your memory layout.
4826
4827@menu
4828* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4829* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4830* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4831* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4832* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4833@end menu
4834
4835@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4836@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4837@cindex input section basics
4838An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4839by a list of section names in parentheses.
4840
4841The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4842describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4843
4844The most common input section description is to include all input
4845sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4846include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4847@smallexample
4848*(.text)
4849@end smallexample
4850@noindent
18625d54 4851Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4852@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4853of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4854match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4855example:
252b5132 4856@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4857EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4858@end smallexample
4859@noindent
4860will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4861and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4862placed inside the section list, for example:
4863@smallexample
b4346c09 4864*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4865@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4866@noindent
4867The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4868two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4869more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4870
4871There are two ways to include more than one section:
4872@smallexample
4873*(.text .rdata)
4874*(.text) *(.rdata)
4875@end smallexample
4876@noindent
4877The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4878@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4879first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4880they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4881@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4882@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4883
8f1732fc
AB
4884When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4885is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4886immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4887@smallexample
4888*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4889@end smallexample
4890@noindent
4891will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4892@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4893from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4894exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4895could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4896@smallexample
4897*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4898@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4899@noindent
4900Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4901before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4902all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4903@smallexample
4904EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4905@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4906
252b5132
RH
4907You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4908You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4909needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4910@smallexample
4911data.o(.data)
4912@end smallexample
4913
ae17ab41
CM
4914To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4915of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4916
4917Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4918
4919@smallexample
4920@group
4921SECTIONS @{
4922 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4923 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4924@}
4925@end group
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4929input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4930@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4931@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4932whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4933
967928e9
AM
4934You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4935matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4936with no whitespace around the colon.
4937
4938@table @samp
4939@item archive:file
4940matches file within archive
4941@item archive:
4942matches the whole archive
4943@item :file
4944matches file but not one in an archive
4945@end table
4946
4947Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4948wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4949single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4950@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4951within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4952also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4953other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4954from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4955command.
4956
252b5132
RH
4957If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4958the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4959commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4960@smallexample
4961data.o
4962@end smallexample
4963
967928e9
AM
4964When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4965and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4966characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4967name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4968did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4969though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4970@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4971the archive search path.
4972
4973@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4974@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4975@cindex input section wildcards
4976@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4977@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4978@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4979In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4980name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4981
4982The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4983pattern for the file name.
4984
4985The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4986
4987@table @samp
4988@item *
4989matches any number of characters
4990@item ?
4991matches any single character
4992@item [@var{chars}]
4993matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4994character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4995@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4996@item \
4997quotes the following character
4998@end table
4999
5000When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
5001will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
5002Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
5003exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
5004@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
5005a @samp{/} character.
5006
5007File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5008specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5009does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5010
5011If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5012appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5013will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5014sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5015@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5016@smallexample
5017.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5018.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5019@end smallexample
5020
bcaa7b3e 5021@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5022Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5023in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5024this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5025pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5026@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5027into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5028
bcaa7b3e 5029@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5030@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5031@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5032alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5033alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5034needed.
bcaa7b3e 5035
02ecc8e9 5036@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5037@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5038@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5039numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5040section name before placing them in the output file. In
5041@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5042the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5043@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5044
bcaa7b3e
L
5045@cindex SORT
5046@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5047
5048When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5049can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5050
5051@enumerate
5052@item
5053@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5054It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5055sections have the same name.
5056@item
5057@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5058It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5059sections have the same alignment.
5060@item
c0065db7 5061@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5062treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5063@item
5064@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5065is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5066@item
5067All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5068@end enumerate
5069
a05a5b64 5070When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5071section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5072takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5073
5074If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5075command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5076treated as nested sorting command.
5077
5078@enumerate
5079@item
5080@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5081@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5082@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5083@item
5084@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5085@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5086@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5087@end enumerate
5088
5089If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5090command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5091
eda680f8 5092@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5093@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5094section sorting option.
5095
252b5132
RH
5096If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5097@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5098precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5099
5100This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5101files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5102sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5103The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5104with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5105linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5106@smallexample
5107@group
5108SECTIONS @{
5109 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5110 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5111 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5112 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5113@}
5114@end group
5115@end smallexample
5116
5117@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5118@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5119@cindex common symbol placement
5120@cindex uninitialized data placement
5121A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5122file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5123linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5124named @samp{COMMON}.
5125
5126You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5127other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5128particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5129input files are placed in another section.
5130
5131In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5132@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5133@smallexample
5134.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5135@end smallexample
5136
5137@cindex scommon section
5138@cindex small common symbols
5139Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5140example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5141symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5142different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5143the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5144symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5145to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5146locations.
5147
5148@cindex [COMMON]
5149You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5150notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5151@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5152
5153@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5154@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5155@cindex KEEP
5156@cindex garbage collection
5157When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5158it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5159This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5160with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5161@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5162
5163@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5164@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5165The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5166to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5167start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5168@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5169follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5170@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5171@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5172All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5173files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5174
5175@smallexample
5176@group
5177SECTIONS @{
5178 outputa 0x10000 :
5179 @{
5180 all.o
5181 foo.o (.input1)
5182 @}
36f63dca
NC
5183@end group
5184@group
252b5132
RH
5185 outputb :
5186 @{
5187 foo.o (.input2)
5188 foo1.o (.input1)
5189 @}
36f63dca
NC
5190@end group
5191@group
252b5132
RH
5192 outputc :
5193 @{
5194 *(.input1)
5195 *(.input2)
5196 @}
5197@}
5198@end group
a1ab1d2a 5199@end smallexample
252b5132 5200
cbd0eecf
L
5201If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5202and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5203automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5204__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5205indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5206respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5207C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5208
252b5132 5209@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5210@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5211@cindex data
5212@cindex section data
5213@cindex output section data
5214@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5215@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5216@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5217@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5218@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5219You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5220@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5221an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5222parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5223value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5224counter.
5225
5226The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5227store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5228bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5229stored.
5230
5231For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5232of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5233@smallexample
5234BYTE(1)
5235LONG(addr)
5236@end smallexample
5237
5238When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5239same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5240target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5241@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5242@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5243
5244If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5245which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5246When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5247true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5248endianness of the first input object file.
5249
36f63dca 5250Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5251between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5252@smallexample
5253SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5254@end smallexample
5255whereas this will work:
5256@smallexample
5257SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5258@end smallexample
5259
252b5132
RH
5260@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5261@cindex holes, filling
5262@cindex unspecified memory
5263You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5264current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5265otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5266gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5267with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5268necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5269point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5270than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5271different parts of an output section.
5272
5273This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5274value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5275@smallexample
563e308f 5276FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5277@end smallexample
5278
5279The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5280section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5281part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5282entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5283precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5284expression.
252b5132
RH
5285
5286@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5287@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5288There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5289commands.
5290
5291@table @code
5292@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5293@cindex input filename symbols
5294@cindex filename symbols
5295@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5296The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5297The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5298file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5299the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5300
5301This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5302normally used for any other object file format.
5303
5304@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5305@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5306@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5307@item CONSTRUCTORS
5308When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5309unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5310destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5311arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5312automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5313For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5314linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5315@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5316ignored for other object file formats.
5317
5318The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5319constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5320Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5321the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5322first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5323of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5324compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5325formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5326@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5327the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5328destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5329@code{exit}.
5330
5331For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5332arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5333addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5334and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5335linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5336runtime code expects to see.
5337
5338@smallexample
5339 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5340 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5341 *(.ctors)
5342 LONG(0)
5343 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5344 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5345 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5346 *(.dtors)
5347 LONG(0)
5348 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5349@end smallexample
5350
5351If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5352which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5353are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5354are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5355command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5356@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5357@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5358@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5359
5360Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5361and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5362need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5363scripts.
5364
5365@end table
5366
5367@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5368@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5369@cindex discarding sections
5370@cindex sections, discarding
5371@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5372The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5373This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5374may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5375@smallexample
49c13adb 5376.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5377@end smallexample
5378@noindent
5379will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5380@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5381sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5382space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5383too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5384space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5385@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5386@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5387This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5388
a0976ea4 5389The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5390on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5391symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5392the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5393section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5394
5395@cindex /DISCARD/
5396The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5397input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5398section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5399
99fabbc9
JL
5400This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5401@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5402garbage collection.
5403
a2e098c3
NC
5404Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5405discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5406members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5407Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5408
252b5132 5409@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5410@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5411@cindex output section attributes
5412We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5413like this:
0c71d759 5414
252b5132 5415@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5416@group
7e7d5768 5417@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5418 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5419 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5420 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5421 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5422 @{
5423 @var{output-section-command}
5424 @var{output-section-command}
5425 @dots{}
562d3460 5426 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5427@end group
5428@end smallexample
0c71d759 5429
252b5132
RH
5430We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5431@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5432remaining section attributes.
5433
a1ab1d2a 5434@menu
252b5132
RH
5435* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5436* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5437* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5438* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5439* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5440* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5441* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5442* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5443@end menu
5444
5445@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5446@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5447Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5448parentheses. The following types are defined:
5449
5450@table @code
5451@item NOLOAD
5452The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5453loaded into memory when the program is run.
5454@item DSECT
5455@itemx COPY
5456@itemx INFO
5457@itemx OVERLAY
5458These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5459rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5460marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5461section when the program is run.
5462@end table
5463
5464@kindex NOLOAD
5465@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5466@cindex loading, preventing
5467The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5468the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5469the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5470@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5471need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5472@smallexample
5473@group
5474SECTIONS @{
5475 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5476 @dots{}
5477@}
5478@end group
5479@end smallexample
5480
5481@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5482@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5483@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5484@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5485@cindex load address
5486@cindex section load address
5487Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5488@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5489@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5490specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5491address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5492
ea5cae92
NC
5493The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5494specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5495takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5496load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5497region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5498
5499If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5500section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5501load address:
5502
5503@itemize @bullet
5504@item
5505If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5506the LMA address as well.
5507
5508@item
5509If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5510
5511@item
5512Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5513with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5514section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5515VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5516the last section in the located region.
5517
5518@item
5519If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5520that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5521
5522@item
5523If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5524section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5525@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5526
5527@cindex ROM initialized data
5528@cindex initialized data in ROM
5529This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5530example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5531called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5532@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5533even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5534uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5535defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5536counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5537
5538@smallexample
5539@group
5540SECTIONS
5541 @{
5542 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5543 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5544 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5545 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5546 .bss 0x3000 :
5547 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5548@}
5549@end group
5550@end smallexample
5551
5552The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5553this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5554the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5555how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5556script.
5557
5558@smallexample
5559@group
5560extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5561char *src = &_etext;
5562char *dst = &_data;
5563
ea5cae92
NC
5564/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5565while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5566 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5567
ea5cae92 5568/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5569for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5570 *dst = 0;
5571@end group
5572@end smallexample
5573
bbf115d3
L
5574@node Forced Output Alignment
5575@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5576@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5577@cindex forcing output section alignment
5578@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5579You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5580alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5581intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5582
7e7d5768
AM
5583@node Forced Input Alignment
5584@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5585@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5586@cindex forcing input section alignment
5587@cindex input section alignment
5588You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5589SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5590sections, whether larger or smaller.
5591
0c71d759
NC
5592@node Output Section Constraint
5593@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5594@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5595@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5596@cindex constraints on output sections
5597You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5598of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5599read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5600@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5601
252b5132 5602@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5603@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5604@kindex >@var{region}
5605@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5606@cindex memory regions and sections
5607You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5608using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5609
5610Here is a simple example:
5611@smallexample
5612@group
5613MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5614SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5615@end group
5616@end smallexample
5617
5618@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5619@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5620@kindex :@var{phdr}
5621@cindex section, assigning to program header
5622@cindex program headers and sections
5623You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5624using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5625one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5626assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5627@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5628linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5629
5630Here is a simple example:
5631@smallexample
5632@group
5633PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5634SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5635@end group
5636@end smallexample
5637
5638@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5639@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5640@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5641@cindex section fill pattern
5642@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5643You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5644@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5645(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5646within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5647alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5648necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5649of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5650an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5651fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5652other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5653pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5654expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5655
5656You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5657output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5658
5659Here is a simple example:
5660@smallexample
5661@group
563e308f 5662SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5663@end group
5664@end smallexample
5665
5666@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5667@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5668@kindex OVERLAY
5669@cindex overlays
5670An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5671are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5672the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5673copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5674required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5675can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5676than another.
5677
5678Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5679@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5680output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5681command is as follows:
5682@smallexample
5683@group
5684OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5685 @{
5686 @var{secname1}
5687 @{
5688 @var{output-section-command}
5689 @var{output-section-command}
5690 @dots{}
5691 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5692 @var{secname2}
5693 @{
5694 @var{output-section-command}
5695 @var{output-section-command}
5696 @dots{}
5697 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5698 @dots{}
abc9061b 5699 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5700@end group
5701@end smallexample
5702
5703Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5704section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5705section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5706those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5707except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5708sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5709
abc9061b
CC
5710The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5711the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5712
252b5132
RH
5713The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5714addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5715memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5716whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5717and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5718and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5719
56dd11f0
NC
5720If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5721references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5722the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5723sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5724@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5725
5726For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5727provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5728defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5729@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5730the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5731within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5732symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5733
5734At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5735the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5736
5737Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5738@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5739@smallexample
5740@group
5741 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5742 @{
5743 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5744 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5745 @}
5746@end group
5747@end smallexample
5748@noindent
5749This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5750address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5751@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5752following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5753@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5754@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5755
5756C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5757like the following.
5758
5759@smallexample
5760@group
5761 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5762 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5763 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5764@end group
5765@end smallexample
5766
5767Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5768everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5769example could have been written identically as follows.
5770
5771@smallexample
5772@group
5773 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5774 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5775 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5776 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5777 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5778 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5779 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5780@end group
5781@end smallexample
5782
5783@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5784@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5785@kindex MEMORY
5786@cindex memory regions
5787@cindex regions of memory
5788@cindex allocating memory
5789@cindex discontinuous memory
5790The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5791memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5792
5793The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5794memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5795may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5796can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5797set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5798regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5799around to fit into the available regions.
5800
127fcdff
AB
5801A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5802however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5803specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5804@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5805@smallexample
5806@group
a1ab1d2a 5807MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5808 @{
5809 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5810 @dots{}
5811 @}
5812@end group
5813@end smallexample
5814
5815The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5816region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5817Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5818with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5819must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5820add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5821command.
252b5132
RH
5822
5823@cindex memory region attributes
5824The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5825whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5826not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5827@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5828section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5829the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5830them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5831
5832The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5833@table @samp
5834@item R
5835Read-only section
5836@item W
5837Read/write section
5838@item X
5839Executable section
5840@item A
5841Allocatable section
5842@item I
5843Initialized section
5844@item L
5845Same as @samp{I}
5846@item !
c09e9a8c 5847Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5848@end table
5849
81c688d5 5850If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5851@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5852attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5853unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5854not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5855string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5856or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5857the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5858
5859@kindex ORIGIN =
5860@kindex o =
5861@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5862The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5863the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5864cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5865abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5866@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5867
5868@kindex LENGTH =
5869@kindex len =
5870@kindex l =
5871The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5872region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5873be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5874@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5875
5876In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5877available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5878and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5879linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5880is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5881or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5882explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5883region.
5884
5885@smallexample
5886@group
a1ab1d2a 5887MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5888 @{
5889 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5890 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5891 @}
5892@end group
5893@end smallexample
5894
5895Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5896specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5897@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5898a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5899output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5900was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5901the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5902output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5903region, the linker will issue an error message.
5904
3ec57632 5905It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5906expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5907@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5908
5909@smallexample
5910@group
c0065db7 5911 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5912@end group
5913@end smallexample
5914
252b5132
RH
5915@node PHDRS
5916@section PHDRS Command
5917@kindex PHDRS
5918@cindex program headers
5919@cindex ELF program headers
5920@cindex program segments
5921@cindex segments, ELF
5922The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5923@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5924loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5925program with the @samp{-p} option.
5926
5927When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5928reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5929program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5930This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5931interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5932
5933The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5934in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5935precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5936the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5937not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5938
5939The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5940generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5941ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5942
5943This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5944@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5945
5946@smallexample
5947@group
5948PHDRS
5949@{
5950 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5951 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5952@}
5953@end group
5954@end smallexample
5955
5956The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5957of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5958header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5959with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5960must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5961is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5962
5963Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5964system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5965specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5966sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5967attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5968Section Phdr}.
5969
5970It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5971merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5972repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5973contain the section.
5974
5975If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5976then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5977not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5978convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5979placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5980default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5981segment at all.
5982
5983@kindex FILEHDR
5984@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5985You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5986the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5987The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5988file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5989include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5990segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5991these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5992
5993The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5994value of the keyword.
5995
5996@table @asis
5997@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5998Indicates an unused program header.
5999
6000@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6001Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6002the file.
6003
6004@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6005Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6006
6007@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6008Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6009found.
6010
6011@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6012Indicates a segment holding note information.
6013
6014@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6015A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6016ABI.
6017
6018@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6019Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6020
1a9ccd70
NC
6021@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6022Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6023
252b5132
RH
6024@item @var{expression}
6025An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6026be used for types not defined above.
6027@end table
6028
6029You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6030in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6031@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6032Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6033output section attribute.
6034
6035The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6036which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6037explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6038an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6039header.
6040
6041Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6042headers used on a native ELF system.
6043
6044@example
6045@group
6046PHDRS
6047@{
6048 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6049 interp PT_INTERP ;
6050 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6051 data PT_LOAD ;
6052 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6053@}
6054
6055SECTIONS
6056@{
6057 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6058 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6059 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6060 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6061 @dots{}
6062 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6063 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6064 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6065 @dots{}
6066@}
6067@end group
6068@end example
6069
6070@node VERSION
6071@section VERSION Command
6072@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6073@cindex symbol versions
6074@cindex version script
6075@cindex versions of symbols
6076The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6077only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6078symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6079a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6080shared library.
6081
6082You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6083you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6084also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6085
6086The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6087@smallexample
6088VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6089@end smallexample
6090
6091The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6092Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6093version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6094version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6095version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6096scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6097library.
6098
6099The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6100examples.
6101
6102@smallexample
6103VERS_1.1 @{
6104 global:
6105 foo1;
6106 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6107 old*;
6108 original*;
6109 new*;
252b5132
RH
6110@};
6111
6112VERS_1.2 @{
6113 foo2;
6114@} VERS_1.1;
6115
6116VERS_2.0 @{
6117 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6118 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6119 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6120 "f(int, double)";
6121 @};
252b5132
RH
6122@} VERS_1.2;
6123@end smallexample
6124
6125This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6126version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6127The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6128a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6129of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6130symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6131is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6132in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6133However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6134name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6135
6136Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6137depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6138to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6139
6140Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6141depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6142and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6143
6144When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6145specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6146unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6147unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6148somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6149wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6150wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6151set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6152ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6153
6154The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6155they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6156could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6157However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6158
0f6bf451 6159Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6160in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6161symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6162won't.
6163
6164@smallexample
7c9c73be 6165@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6166@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6167
252b5132
RH
6168When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6169symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6170requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6171shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6172loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6173linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6174application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6175way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6176all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6177search for each symbol reference.
6178
6179The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6180doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6181that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6182functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6183the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6184required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6185that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6186versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6187the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6188
6189There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6190first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6191source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6192script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6193maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6194@smallexample
6195__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6196@end smallexample
6197@noindent
6198in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6199be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6200The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6201@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6202takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6203
6204The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6205function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6206an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6207version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6208linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6209
6210To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6211source file. Here is an example:
6212
6213@smallexample
6214__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6215__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6216__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6217__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6218@end smallexample
6219
6220In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6221unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6222example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6223@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6224
6225When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6226some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6227this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6228@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6229declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6230you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6231
6232If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6233within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6234(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6235specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6236
cb840a31
L
6237You can also specify the language in the version script:
6238
6239@smallexample
6240VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6241@end smallexample
6242
c0065db7 6243The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6244The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6245demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6246patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6247@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6248
86043bbb
MM
6249Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6250described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6251or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6252the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6253whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6254cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6255might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6256should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6257expect when you upgrade.
6258
252b5132
RH
6259@node Expressions
6260@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6261@cindex expressions
6262@cindex arithmetic
6263The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6264that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6265expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6266host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6267
6268You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6269
6270The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6271expressions.
6272
6273@menu
6274* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6275* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6276* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6277* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6278* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6279* Operators:: Operators
6280* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6281* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6282* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6283@end menu
6284
6285@node Constants
6286@subsection Constants
6287@cindex integer notation
6288@cindex constants in linker scripts
6289All constants are integers.
6290
6291As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6292octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6293hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6294@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6295@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6296value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6297
6298@cindex scaled integers
6299@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6300@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6301@cindex suffixes for integers
6302@cindex integer suffixes
6303In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6304constant by
6305@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6306@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6307@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6308@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6309@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6310@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6311@tex
6312${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6313@end tex
6314@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6315respectively. For example, the following
6316all refer to the same quantity:
6317
252b5132 6318@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6319_fourk_1 = 4K;
6320_fourk_2 = 4096;
6321_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6322_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6323@end smallexample
6324
8a308ae8
NC
6325Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6326conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6327
0c71d759
NC
6328@node Symbolic Constants
6329@subsection Symbolic Constants
6330@cindex symbolic constants
6331@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6332It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6333the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6334
6335@table @code
6336@item MAXPAGESIZE
6337@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6338The target's maximum page size.
6339
6340@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6341@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6342The target's default page size.
6343@end table
6344
6345So for example:
6346
6347@smallexample
9d5777a3 6348 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6349@end smallexample
6350
6351will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6352supported by the target.
6353
252b5132
RH
6354@node Symbols
6355@subsection Symbol Names
6356@cindex symbol names
6357@cindex names
6358@cindex quoted symbol names
6359@kindex "
6360Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6361and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6362Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6363specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6364keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6365@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6366"SECTION" = 9;
6367"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6368@end smallexample
6369
6370Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6371to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6372whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6373
ecca9871
L
6374@node Orphan Sections
6375@subsection Orphan Sections
6376@cindex orphan
6377Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6378are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6379script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6380output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6381in which to place the orphaned input section.
6382
6383If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6384an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6385placed at the end of that output section.
6386
6387If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6388sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6389name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6390orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6391one new output section.
6392
6393If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6394then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6395in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6396linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6397attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6398sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6399support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6400
a05a5b64
TP
6401The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6402(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6403output sections an orphan is placed in.
6404
252b5132
RH
6405@node Location Counter
6406@subsection The Location Counter
6407@kindex .
6408@cindex dot
6409@cindex location counter
6410@cindex current output location
6411The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6412current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6413location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6414within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6415anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6416
6417@cindex holes
6418Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6419moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6420location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6421and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6422doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6423
6424@smallexample
6425SECTIONS
6426@{
6427 output :
6428 @{
6429 file1(.text)
6430 . = . + 1000;
6431 file2(.text)
6432 . += 1000;
6433 file3(.text)
563e308f 6434 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6435@}
6436@end smallexample
6437@noindent
6438In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6439located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6440followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6441@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6442@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6443specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6444
5c6bbab8
NC
6445@cindex dot inside sections
6446Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6447current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6448statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6449absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6450however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6451not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6452
6453@smallexample
6454SECTIONS
6455@{
6456 . = 0x100
6457 .text: @{
6458 *(.text)
6459 . = 0x200
6460 @}
6461 . = 0x500
6462 .data: @{
6463 *(.data)
6464 . += 0x600
6465 @}
6466@}
6467@end smallexample
6468
6469The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6470and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6471the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6472much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6473move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6474and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6475the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6476the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6477
b5666f2f
AM
6478@cindex dot outside sections
6479Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6480output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6481needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6482
6483@smallexample
6484SECTIONS
6485@{
6486 start_of_text = . ;
6487 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6488 end_of_text = . ;
6489
6490 start_of_data = . ;
6491 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6492 end_of_data = . ;
6493@}
6494@end smallexample
6495
6496If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6497not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6498between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6499should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6500blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6501the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6502sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6503statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6504special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6505place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6506as follows:
6507
6508@smallexample
6509SECTIONS
6510@{
6511 start_of_text = . ;
6512 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6513 end_of_text = . ;
6514
6515 start_of_data = . ;
6516 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6517 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6518 end_of_data = . ;
6519@}
6520@end smallexample
6521
6522This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6523@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6524placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6525assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6526a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6527section. So you could write:
6528
6529@smallexample
6530SECTIONS
6531@{
6532 start_of_text = . ;
6533 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6534 end_of_text = . ;
6535
6536 . = . ;
6537 start_of_data = . ;
6538 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6539 end_of_data = . ;
6540@}
6541@end smallexample
6542
6543Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6544@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6545
252b5132
RH
6546@need 2000
6547@node Operators
6548@subsection Operators
6549@cindex operators for arithmetic
6550@cindex arithmetic operators
6551@cindex precedence in expressions
6552The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6553the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6554@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6555@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6556@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6557@smallexample
6558precedence associativity Operators Notes
6559(highest)
65601 left ! - ~ (1)
65612 left * / %
65623 left + -
65634 left >> <<
65645 left == != > < <= >=
65656 left &
65667 left |
65678 left &&
65689 left ||
656910 right ? :
657011 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6571(lowest)
6572@end smallexample
6573Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6574(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6575(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6576@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6577@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6578@tex
6579\vskip \baselineskip
6580%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6581\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6582\hrule
6583\halign
6584{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6585height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6586&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6587height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6588\noalign{\hrule}
6589height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6590&highest&&&&&\cr
6591% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6592&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6593&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6594&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6595&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6596&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6597&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6598&7&&left&&|&\cr
6599&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6600&9&&left&&||&\cr
6601&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6602&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6603&lowest&&&&&\cr
6604height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6605\hrule}
6606@end tex
6607@iftex
6608{
6609@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6610@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6611@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6612}
6613@end iftex
6614@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6615
6616@node Evaluation
6617@subsection Evaluation
6618@cindex lazy evaluation
6619@cindex expression evaluation order
6620The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6621an expression when absolutely necessary.
6622
6623The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6624address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6625regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6626as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6627
6628However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6629until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6630other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6631for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6632
6633The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6634assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6635allocation.
6636
6637Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6638@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6639
6640If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6641available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6642following
6643@smallexample
6644@group
6645SECTIONS
6646 @{
a1ab1d2a 6647 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6648 @{ *(.text) @}
6649 @}
6650@end group
6651@end smallexample
6652@noindent
6653will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6654address}.
6655
6656@node Expression Section
6657@subsection The Section of an Expression
6658@cindex expression sections
6659@cindex absolute expressions
6660@cindex relative expressions
6661@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6662@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6663@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6664Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6665relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6666using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6667value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6668symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6669operations.
6670
abf4be64
AM
6671Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6672section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6673address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6674@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6675functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6676One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6677(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6678differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6679versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6680section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6681Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6682absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6683given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6684everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6685
6686In the following simple example,
252b5132 6687
7542af2a
AM
6688@smallexample
6689@group
6690SECTIONS
6691 @{
6692 . = 0x100;
6693 __executable_start = 0x100;
6694 .data :
6695 @{
6696 . = 0x10;
6697 __data_start = 0x10;
6698 *(.data)
6699 @}
6700 @dots{}
6701 @}
6702@end group
6703@end smallexample
252b5132 6704
7542af2a
AM
6705both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6706address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6707@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6708section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6709
5c3049d2
AM
6710For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6711addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6712
6713@itemize @bullet
6714@item
c05f749e
AM
6715Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6716operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6717absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6718@item
7542af2a
AM
6719Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6720relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6721and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6722@item
c05f749e
AM
6723Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6724in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6725address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6726before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6727@end itemize
6728
6729The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6730
6731@itemize @bullet
6732@item
6733An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6734@item
6735The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6736@item
9bc8bb33 6737The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6738relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6739(after above conversions) is also a number when
6740@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6741but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6742@item
6743The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6744relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6745section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6746@item
6747The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6748conversions) is an absolute address.
6749@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6750
6751You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6752to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6753create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6754section @samp{.data}:
6755@smallexample
6756SECTIONS
6757 @{
6758 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6759 @}
6760@end smallexample
6761@noindent
6762If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6763@samp{.data} section.
6764
7542af2a
AM
6765Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6766particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6767
252b5132
RH
6768@node Builtin Functions
6769@subsection Builtin Functions
6770@cindex functions in expressions
6771The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6772use in linker script expressions.
6773
6774@table @code
6775@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6776@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6777@cindex expression, absolute
6778Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6779of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6780value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6781normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6782
6783@item ADDR(@var{section})
6784@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6785@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6786Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6787script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6788the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6789@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6790@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6791the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6792@smallexample
6793@group
6794SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6795 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6796 @{
252b5132
RH
6797 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6798 @dots{}
6799 @}
6800 .output :
6801 @{
6802 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6803 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6804 @}
6805@dots{} @}
6806@end group
6807@end smallexample
6808
876f4090
NS
6809@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6810@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6811@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6812@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6813@cindex round up location counter
6814@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6815@cindex round up expression
6816@cindex align expression
6817Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6818to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6819doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6820arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6821expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6822equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6823
6824Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6825next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6826variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6827input sections:
252b5132
RH
6828@smallexample
6829@group
6830SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6831 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6832 *(.data)
6833 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6834 @}
6835@dots{} @}
6836@end group
6837@end smallexample
6838@noindent
6839The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6840a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6841a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6842of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6843
6844The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6845
362c1d1a
NS
6846@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6847@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6848@cindex section alignment
6849Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6850been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6851evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6852the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6853value in that section.
6854@smallexample
6855@group
6856SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6857 .output @{
6858 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6859 @dots{}
6860 @}
6861@dots{} @}
6862@end group
6863@end smallexample
6864
252b5132
RH
6865@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6866@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6867This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6868scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6869section.
6870
2d20f7bf
JJ
6871@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6872@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6873This is equivalent to either
6874@smallexample
6875(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6876@end smallexample
6877or
6878@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6879(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6880 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6881@end smallexample
6882@noindent
6883depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6884for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6885@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6886If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6887memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6888bytes in the on-disk file.
6889
6890This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6891any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6892@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6893be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6894running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6895that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6896page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6897
6898@noindent
6899Example:
6900@smallexample
6901 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6902@end smallexample
6903
6904@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6905@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6906This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6907evaluation purposes.
6908
6909@smallexample
6910 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6911@end smallexample
6912
a4f5ad88
JJ
6913@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6914@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6915This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6916@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6917When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6918does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6919@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6920argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6921script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6922@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6923padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6924section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6925
6926@smallexample
6927 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6928@end smallexample
6929
252b5132
RH
6930@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6931@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6932@cindex symbol defaults
6933Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6934defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6935return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6936default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6937shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6938the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6939existed, its value is preserved:
6940
6941@smallexample
6942@group
6943SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6944 .text : @{
6945 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6946 @dots{}
6947 @}
6948 @dots{}
6949@}
6950@end group
6951@end smallexample
6952
3ec57632
NC
6953@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6954@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6955Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6956
252b5132
RH
6957@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6958@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6959@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6960Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6961Section LMA}).
6962
2e53f7d6
NC
6963@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6964@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6965Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6966@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6967
252b5132
RH
6968@kindex MAX
6969@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6970Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6971
6972@kindex MIN
6973@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6974Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6975
6976@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6977@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6978@cindex unallocated address, next
6979Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6980This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6981use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6982output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6983
3ec57632
NC
6984@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6985@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6986Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6987
ba916c8a
MM
6988@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6989@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6990Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6991value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6992@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6993will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6994can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6995``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6996name.
6997
252b5132
RH
6998@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6999@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7000@cindex section size
7001Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
7002been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
7003evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
7004@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
7005@smallexample
7006@group
7007SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7008 .output @{
7009 .start = . ;
7010 @dots{}
7011 .end = . ;
7012 @}
7013 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7014 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7015@dots{} @}
7016@end group
7017@end smallexample
7018
7019@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
7020@itemx sizeof_headers
7021@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7022@cindex header size
7023Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7024information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7025this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7026choose, to facilitate paging.
7027
7028@cindex not enough room for program headers
7029@cindex program headers, not enough room
7030When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7031@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7032number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7033addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7034additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7035room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7036the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7037script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7038you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7039command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7040@end table
7041
7042@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7043@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7044@cindex implicit linker scripts
7045If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7046an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7047linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7048linker will report an error.
7049
7050An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7051
7052Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7053assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7054commands.
7055
7056Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7057at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7058read. This can affect archive searching.
7059
bf6d8037
HC
7060@node Plugins
7061@chapter Linker Plugins
7062
7063@cindex plugins
7064@cindex linker plugins
7065The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7066For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7067support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7068
7069Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7070be added here later.
7071
7072@menu
7073* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7074@end menu
7075
7076@node libdep Plugin
7077@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7078@cindex static library dependencies
7079Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7080just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7081optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7082within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7083rose to ascendance.
7084
7085One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7086multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7087dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7088library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7089referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7090link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7091libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7092explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7093
7094The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7095to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7096plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7097dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7098and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7099command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7100utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7101being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7102archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7103
7104For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7105library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7106the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7107
7108@smallexample
7109-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7110@end smallexample
7111
252b5132
RH
7112@ifset GENERIC
7113@node Machine Dependent
7114@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7115
7116@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7117@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7118sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7119functionality are not listed.
7120
7121@menu
36f63dca
NC
7122@ifset H8300
7123* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7124@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7125@ifset M68HC11
7126* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7127@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7128@ifset ARM
7129* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7130@end ifset
7131@ifset HPPA
7132* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7133@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7134@ifset M68K
7135* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7136@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7137@ifset MIPS
7138* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7139@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7140@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7141* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7142@end ifset
2469cfa2 7143@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7144* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7145@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7146@ifset NDS32
7147* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7148@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7149@ifset NIOSII
7150* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7151@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7152@ifset POWERPC
7153* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7154@end ifset
7155@ifset POWERPC64
7156* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7157@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7158@ifset S/390
7159* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7160@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7161@ifset SPU
7162* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7163@end ifset
74459f0e 7164@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7165* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7166@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7167@ifset WIN32
7168* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7169@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7170@ifset XTENSA
7171* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7172@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7173@end menu
7174@end ifset
7175
252b5132
RH
7176@ifset H8300
7177@ifclear GENERIC
7178@raisesections
7179@end ifclear
7180
7181@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7182@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7183
7184@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7185For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7186you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7187
7188@table @emph
7189@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7190@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7191@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7192targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7193program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7194respectively.
7195
7196@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7197@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7198@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7199@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7200sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7201page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7202(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7203@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7204top page of memory).
1502569c 7205
81f5558e
NC
7206@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7207indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7208displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7209the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7210@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7211whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7212range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7213
1502569c 7214@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7215@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7216biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7217which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7218page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7219(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7220@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7221the top page of memory).
7222
7223@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7224@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
722532 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7226changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7227(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7228@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7229the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7230@end table
7231
7232@ifclear GENERIC
7233@lowersections
7234@end ifclear
7235@end ifset
7236
36f63dca 7237@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7238@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7239@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7240@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7241@node Renesas
7242@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7243
c2dcd04e
NC
7244@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7245H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7246options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7247@end ifset
7248@end ifclear
7249
36f63dca
NC
7250@ifset ARM
7251@ifclear GENERIC
7252@raisesections
7253@end ifclear
7254
93fd0973
SC
7255@ifset M68HC11
7256@ifclear GENERIC
7257@raisesections
7258@end ifclear
7259
7260@node M68HC11/68HC12
7261@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7262
7263@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7264
7265@subsection Linker Relaxation
7266
7267For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7268optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7269
7270@table @emph
7271@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7272@item relaxing address modes
7273@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7274targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7275program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7276respectively.
7277
7278@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7279transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7280page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7281
7282@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7283When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7284of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7285addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7286@code{bset} instructions.
7287
7288@end table
7289
7290@subsection Trampoline Generation
7291
7292@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7293@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7294For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7295call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7296will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7297trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7298case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7299point to the function trampoline.
7300
7301@ifclear GENERIC
7302@lowersections
7303@end ifclear
7304@end ifset
7305
36f63dca 7306@node ARM
3674e28a 7307@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7308
7309@cindex ARM interworking support
7310@kindex --support-old-code
7311For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7312between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7313been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7314line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7315libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7316option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7317given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7318which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7319the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7320non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7321
7322@cindex thumb entry point
7323@cindex entry point, thumb
7324@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7325The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7326@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7327But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7328branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7329executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7330
ce11ba6c
KT
7331@cindex PE import table prefixing
7332@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7333The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7334the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7335element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7336import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7337
e489d0ae
PB
7338@cindex BE8
7339@kindex --be8
7340The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7341executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7342objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7343option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7344little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7345
3674e28a
PB
7346@cindex TARGET1
7347@kindex --target1-rel
7348@kindex --target1-abs
7349The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7350@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7351or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7352and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7353
7354@cindex TARGET2
7355@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7356The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7357@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7358meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7359@table @samp
7360@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7361@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7362@item abs
a57d1773 7363@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7364@item got-rel
7365@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7366@end table
7367
319850b4
JB
7368@cindex FIX_V4BX
7369@kindex --fix-v4bx
7370The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7371specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7372interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7373also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7374
7375In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7376linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7377@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7378
7379In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7380relocations are ignored.
7381
845b51d6
PB
7382@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7383@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7384Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7385relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7386
7387@smallexample
7388TST rM, #1
7389MOVEQ PC, rM
7390BX Rn
7391@end smallexample
7392
7393This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7394and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7395condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7396
33bfe774
JB
7397@cindex USE_BLX
7398@kindex --use-blx
7399The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7400BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7401situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7402code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7403each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7404
c6dd86c6
JB
7405@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7406@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7407The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7408bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7409instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7410to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7411the support code can read the intended values.
7412
7413The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7414intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7415and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7416intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7417full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7418you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7419
7420If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7421enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7422@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7423mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7424vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7425@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7426
7427If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7428potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7429such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7430first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7431instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7432the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7433are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7434
2de70689
MGD
7435@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7436@kindex --fix-arm1176
7437@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7438The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7439in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7440are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7441unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7442
9d5777a3 7443Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7444Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7445http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7446
a504d23a
LA
7447@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7448@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7449
7450The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7451workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7452the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7453off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7454the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7455core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7456integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7457VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7458
7459The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7460necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7461
7462The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7463@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7464STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7465linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7466@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7467
7468If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7469potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7470such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7471replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7472branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7473then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7474
7475The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7476the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7477
7478The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7479they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7480there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7481occurs.
7482
7483The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7484PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7485large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7486cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7487occurs.
7488
bf21ed78
MS
7489@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7490@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7491The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7492warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7493enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7494linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7495using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7496not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7497
7498@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7499@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7500The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7501warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7502@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7503linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7504using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7505
726150b7
NC
7506@cindex PIC_VENEER
7507@kindex --pic-veneer
7508The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7509ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7510is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7511@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7512
7513@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7514@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7515The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7516code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7517perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7518placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7519controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7520The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7521duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7522group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7523code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7524where they should be placed.
7525
7526The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7527@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7528placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7529branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7530placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7531value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7532exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7533A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7534linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7535from the input sections.
7536
7537The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7538@samp{N = +1}.
7539
1a51c1a4
NC
7540Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7541only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7542otherwise.
7543
1db37fe6
YG
7544@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7545@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7546@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7547The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7548
7549The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7550
68fcca92
JW
7551@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7552@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7553@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7554The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7555
7556Please contact ARM for further details.
7557
1db37fe6
YG
7558@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7559@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7560@cindex Merging exidx entries
7561The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7562
7563@kindex --long-plt
7564@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7565The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7566which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7567entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7568
1f56df9d
JW
7569@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7570@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7571The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7572link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7573
4ba2ef8f
TP
7574@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7575All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7576Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7577@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7578veneers in memory.
7579
54ddd295
TP
7580@kindex --cmse-implib
7581@cindex Secure gateway import library
7582The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7583specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7584secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7585executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7586
0955507f
TP
7587@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7588@cindex Input import library
7589The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7590must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7591given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7592in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7593@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7594library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7595library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7596for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7597specified.
7598
36f63dca
NC
7599@ifclear GENERIC
7600@lowersections
7601@end ifclear
7602@end ifset
7603
7604@ifset HPPA
7605@ifclear GENERIC
7606@raisesections
7607@end ifclear
7608
7609@node HPPA ELF32
7610@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7611@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7612@kindex --multi-subspace
7613When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7614import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7615The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7616stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7617multiple sub-spaces.
7618
7619@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7620@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7621Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7622stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7623@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7624sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7625a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7626the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7627conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7628prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7629A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7630branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7631@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7632@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7633detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7634positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7635
7636Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7637single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7638create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7639large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7640
7641@ifclear GENERIC
7642@lowersections
7643@end ifclear
7644@end ifset
7645
7fb9f789
NC
7646@ifset M68K
7647@ifclear GENERIC
7648@raisesections
7649@end ifclear
7650
7651@node M68K
7652@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7653
7654@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7655@kindex --got=@var{type}
7656The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7657The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7658@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7659the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7660@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7661entries only at non-negative offsets.
7662@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7663entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7664support such GOTs.
7665@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7666output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7667file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7668files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7669
7670@ifclear GENERIC
7671@lowersections
7672@end ifclear
7673@end ifset
7674
833794fc
MR
7675@ifset MIPS
7676@ifclear GENERIC
7677@raisesections
7678@end ifclear
7679
7680@node MIPS
7681@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7682
7683@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7684@kindex --insn32
7685@kindex --no-insn32
7686The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7687microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7688in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7689used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7690or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7691including 16-bit ones where possible.
7692
8b10b0b3
MR
7693@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7694@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7695@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7696The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7697control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7698@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7699relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7700calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7701relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7702instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7703or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7704the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7705
833794fc
MR
7706@ifclear GENERIC
7707@lowersections
7708@end ifclear
7709@end ifset
7710
36f63dca
NC
7711@ifset MMIX
7712@ifclear GENERIC
7713@raisesections
7714@end ifclear
7715
7716@node MMIX
7717@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7718For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7719@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7720understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7721can translate between the two formats.
7722
7723There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7724Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7725registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7726equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7727@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7728global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7729this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7730symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7731
7a2de473
HPN
7732Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7733@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7734The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7735of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7736
7737Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7738are left out from an mmo file.
7739
7740@ifclear GENERIC
7741@lowersections
7742@end ifclear
7743@end ifset
7744
7745@ifset MSP430
7746@ifclear GENERIC
7747@raisesections
7748@end ifclear
7749
7750@node MSP430
7751@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7752For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7753will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7754just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7755
7756@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7757The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7758
7759@table @code
7760@item @samp{.vectors}
7761Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7762
7763@item @samp{.bootloader}
7764Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7765in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7766
7767@item @samp{.infomem}
7768Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7769this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7770
c0065db7 7771@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7772This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7773in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7774
7775@item @samp{.noinit}
7776Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7777
c0065db7 7778The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7779@end table
7780
7ef3addb
JL
7781@table @option
7782@cindex MSP430 Options
7783@kindex --code-region
7784@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7785This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7786argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7787using this option.
7788
7789@kindex --data-region
7790@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7791This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7792[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7793for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7794
7795@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7796@item --disable-sec-transformation
7797Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7798and @code{--data-region} options.
7799This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7800wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7801not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7802@end table
7803
36f63dca
NC
7804@ifclear GENERIC
7805@lowersections
7806@end ifclear
7807@end ifset
7808
35c08157
KLC
7809@ifset NDS32
7810@ifclear GENERIC
7811@raisesections
7812@end ifclear
7813
7814@node NDS32
7815@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7816@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7817For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7818relaxes objects according to these options.
7819
7820@table @code
7821@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7822Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7823
7824@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7825Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7826
7827@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7828Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7829
7830@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7831Export the EX9 table after linking.
7832
7833@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7834Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7835
7836@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7837Update the existing EX9 table.
7838
7839@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7840Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7841
7842@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7843Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7844
7845@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7846Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7847
7848@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7849Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7850@end table
7851
7852@ifclear GENERIC
7853@lowersections
7854@end ifclear
7855@end ifset
7856
78058a5e
SL
7857@ifset NIOSII
7858@ifclear GENERIC
7859@raisesections
7860@end ifclear
7861
7862@node Nios II
7863@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7864@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7865@kindex --relax on Nios II
7866
7867Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7868transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7869which may result in @command{ld} giving
7870@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7871The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7872trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7873outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7874trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7875be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7876larger than 256MB.
7877
7878The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7879is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7880@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7881locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7882source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7883register as a temporary.
7884
7885Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7886relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7887option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7888
7889@ifclear GENERIC
7890@lowersections
7891@end ifclear
7892@end ifset
7893
2a60a7a8
AM
7894@ifset POWERPC
7895@ifclear GENERIC
7896@raisesections
7897@end ifclear
7898
7899@node PowerPC ELF32
7900@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7901@cindex PowerPC long branches
7902@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7903Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7904displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7905@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7906@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7907the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7908section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7909section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7910@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7911both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7912considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7913
7914@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7915@table @option
7916@cindex PowerPC PLT
7917@kindex --bss-plt
7918@item --bss-plt
7919Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7920generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7921the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7922writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7923@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7924PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7925compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7926BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7927
016687f8
AM
7928@kindex --secure-plt
7929@item --secure-plt
7930@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7931@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7932when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7933layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7934style BSS PLT.
7935
2a60a7a8
AM
7936@cindex PowerPC GOT
7937@kindex --sdata-got
7938@item --sdata-got
7939The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7940sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7941@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7942section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7943@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7944@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7945@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7946@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7947PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7948pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7949GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7950really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7951
7952@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7953@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7954@item --emit-stub-syms
7955This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7956symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7957
7958@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7959@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7960@item --no-tls-optimize
7961PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7962sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7963disable the optimization.
7964@end table
7965
7966@ifclear GENERIC
7967@lowersections
7968@end ifclear
7969@end ifset
7970
7971@ifset POWERPC64
7972@ifclear GENERIC
7973@raisesections
7974@end ifclear
7975
7976@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7977@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7978
7979@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7980@table @option
7981@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7982@kindex --stub-group-size
7983@item --stub-group-size
7984Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7985by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7986@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7987sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7988a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7989the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7990conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7991prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7992A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7993branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7994@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7995@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7996detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7997positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7998
7999Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8000single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8001create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8002large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8003
8004@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8005@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8006@item --emit-stub-syms
8007This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8008symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8009
8010@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8011@kindex --dotsyms
8012@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8013@item --dotsyms
8014@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8015These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8016in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8017function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8018code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8019properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8020to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8021@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8022dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8023feature.
8024
7ae4ea7d
AM
8025@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8026@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8027@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8028@item --save-restore-funcs
8029@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8030These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8031provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8032@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8033function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8034link.
8035
2a60a7a8
AM
8036@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8037@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8038@item --no-tls-optimize
8039PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8040sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8041disable the optimization.
8042
7c9cf415
AM
8043@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8044@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8045@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8046@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8047@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8048@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8049@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8050These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8051stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8052an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8053@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8054stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8055generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8056__tls_get_addr_opt.
8057Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8058much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8059an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8060will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8061@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8062and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8063this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8064Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8065@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8066register saves.
7c9cf415 8067
2a60a7a8
AM
8068@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8069@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8070@item --no-opd-optimize
8071PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8072corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8073the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8074Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8075
8076@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8077@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8078@item --non-overlapping-opd
8079Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8080@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8081the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8082entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8083
8084@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8085@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8086@item --no-toc-optimize
8087PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8088entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8089reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8090marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8091marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8092relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8093unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8094reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8095discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8096reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8097code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8098optimization.
8099
d882c988
AM
8100@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8101@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8102@item --no-inline-optimize
8103PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8104marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8105@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8106a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8107locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8108disables that optimization.
8109
2a60a7a8
AM
8110@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8111@kindex --no-multi-toc
8112@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8113If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8114@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8115where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8116entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8117total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8118grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8119TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8120calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8121help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
812264K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8123Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8124
8125@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8126@kindex --no-toc-sort
8127@item --no-toc-sort
8128By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8129happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8130placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8131with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8132referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8133@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8134results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8135off this feature.
8136
8137@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8138@kindex --plt-align
8139@kindex --no-plt-align
8140@item --plt-align
8141@itemx --no-plt-align
8142Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8143aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8144boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8145specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8146specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8147if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8148PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8149
8150@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8151@kindex --plt-static-chain
8152@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8153@item --plt-static-chain
8154@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8155Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8156chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8157chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8158
8159@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8160@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8161@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8162@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8163@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8164With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8165lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8166another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8167order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8168memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8169barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8170looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8171seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8172default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8173
8174@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8175@kindex --plt-localentry
8176@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8177@item --plt-localentry
8178@itemx --no-localentry
8179ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8180ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8181(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8182Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8183or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8184functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8185in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8186interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8187including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8188to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8189complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8190care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8191
8192@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8193@kindex --power10-stubs
8194@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8195@item --power10-stubs
8196@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8197When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8198relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8199linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8200for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8201power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8202power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8203allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8204@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8205auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8206@end table
8207
8208@ifclear GENERIC
8209@lowersections
8210@end ifclear
8211@end ifset
8212
b4cbbe8f
AK
8213@ifset S/390
8214@ifclear GENERIC
8215@raisesections
8216@end ifclear
8217
8218@node S/390 ELF
8219@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8220
8221@cindex S/390 ELF options
8222@table @option
8223
8224@cindex S/390
8225@kindex --s390-pgste
8226@item --s390-pgste
8227This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8228segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8229binaries marked that way.
8230@end table
8231
8232@ifclear GENERIC
8233@lowersections
8234@end ifclear
8235@end ifset
8236
49fa1e15
AM
8237@ifset SPU
8238@ifclear GENERIC
8239@raisesections
8240@end ifclear
8241
8242@node SPU ELF
8243@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8244
8245@cindex SPU ELF options
8246@table @option
8247
8248@cindex SPU plugins
8249@kindex --plugin
8250@item --plugin
8251This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8252
8253@cindex SPU overlays
8254@kindex --no-overlays
8255@item --no-overlays
8256Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8257regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8258@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8259turns off all this special overlay handling.
8260
8261@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8262@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8263@item --emit-stub-syms
8264This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8265symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8266
8267@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8268@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8269@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8270This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8271function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8272on calls to non-overlay regions.
8273
8274@cindex SPU local store size
8275@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8276@item --local-store=lo:hi
8277@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8278the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8279range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8280
c0065db7 8281@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8282@kindex --stack-analysis
8283@item --stack-analysis
8284SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8285unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8286under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8287@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8288@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8289determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8290for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8291for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8292for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8293find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8294and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8295under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8296dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8297is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8298and calls will be given.
8299
c0065db7 8300@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8301@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8302@item --emit-stack-syms
8303This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8304in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8305These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8306functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8307functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8308such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8309The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8310@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8311@end table
8312
8313@ifclear GENERIC
8314@lowersections
8315@end ifclear
8316@end ifset
8317
36f63dca
NC
8318@ifset TICOFF
8319@ifclear GENERIC
8320@raisesections
8321@end ifclear
8322
8323@node TI COFF
8324@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8325@cindex TI COFF versions
8326@kindex --format=@var{version}
8327The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8328TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8329also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8330format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8331header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8332
8333@ifclear GENERIC
8334@lowersections
8335@end ifclear
8336@end ifset
8337
2ca22b03
NC
8338@ifset WIN32
8339@ifclear GENERIC
8340@raisesections
8341@end ifclear
8342
8343@node WIN32
8344@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8345
c0065db7 8346This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8347See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8348command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8349
8350@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8351@cindex import libraries
8352@item import libraries
69da35b5 8353The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8354libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8355regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8356archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8357support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8358@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8359
c0065db7
RM
8360@item exporting DLL symbols
8361@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8362The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8363
8364@table @emph
8365@item using auto-export functionality
8366@cindex using auto-export functionality
8367By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8368which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8369
0a5d968e
NC
8370@itemize
8371@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8372@item --exclude-symbols
8373@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8374@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8375@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8376@end itemize
8377
09e2aba4
DK
8378When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8379(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8380symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8381often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8382private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8383options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8384exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8385final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8386
8387If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8388command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8389if either of the following are true:
8390
8391@itemize
8392@item A DEF file is used.
8393@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8394@end itemize
dc8465bf 8395
c0065db7
RM
8396@item using a DEF file
8397@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8398Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8399an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8400exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8401name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8402command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8403
8404@example
8405gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8406@end example
8407
0a5d968e
NC
8408Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8409@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8410
dc8465bf
NC
8411Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8412
8413@example
4b5bd4e7 8414LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8415
8416EXPORTS
8417foo
8418bar
8419_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8420another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8421var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8422doo = foo == foo2
8423eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8424@end example
dc8465bf 8425
7fcab871 8426This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8427symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8428alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8429by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8430@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8431@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8432export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8433in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8434symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8435
6b31ad16
DS
8436The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8437name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8438the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8439
b45619c0
NC
8440When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8441library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8442@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8443executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8444
8445With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8446specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8447non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8448
8449If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8450or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8451filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8452
4b5bd4e7
DS
8453The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8454
8455@example
8456EXPORTS
8457 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8458 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8459 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8460@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8461
8462Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8463@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8464@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8465@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8466Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8467@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8468string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8469
8470The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8471
8472@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8473will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8474by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8475linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8476library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8477
8478@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8479The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8480the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8481@code{*_imp__foo}).
8482
8483@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8484well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8485read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8486variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8487the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8488extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8489application will behave unexpectedly.
8490
8491@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8492it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8493symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8494API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8495the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8496
4b5bd4e7
DS
8497See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8498other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8499
8500@cindex creating a DEF file
8501While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8502with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8503
8504@item Using decorations
8505@cindex Using decorations
8506Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8507itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8508declared as:
8509
8510@example
8511__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8512__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8513@end example
8514
8515All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8516any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8517this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8518the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8519
8520Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8521decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8522instead:
8523
8524@example
8525__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8526__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8527@end example
8528
c0065db7
RM
8529This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8530when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8531variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8532code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8533of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8534omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8535@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8536information.
c0065db7 8537@end table
dc8465bf 8538
2ca22b03
NC
8539@cindex automatic data imports
8540@item automatic data imports
8541The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8542by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8543compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8544issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8545code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8546c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8547initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8548decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8549platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8550command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8551The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8552suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8553trigger the feature's use.
8554
c0065db7 8555auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8556additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8557
c0065db7 8558"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8559documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8560
c0065db7
RM
8561The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8562occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8563One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8564below.
8565
8566@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8567For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8568object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8569offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8570field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8571in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8572without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8573The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8574references.
8575
c0065db7
RM
8576The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8577be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8578themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8579runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8580compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8581support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8582run without error on an older system.
8583
c0065db7
RM
8584@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8585enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8586
8587@cindex direct linking to a dll
8588@item direct linking to a dll
8589The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8590including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8591libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8592traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8593libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8594function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8595though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8596storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8597tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8598large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8599
c0065db7 8600Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8601@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8602of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8603perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8604select the dll instead of an import library.
8605
2ca22b03 8606
69da35b5
NC
8607For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8608to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8609
8610@example
45e948fe
NC
8611libxxx.dll.a
8612xxx.dll.a
8613libxxx.a
8614xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8615libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8616cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8617libxxx.dll
8618xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8619@end example
8620
69da35b5
NC
8621before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8622
c0065db7
RM
8623(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8624where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8625@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8626file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8627@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8628
c0065db7
RM
8629Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8630@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8631was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8632various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8633could coexist on the same machine.
8634
2ca22b03
NC
8635The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8636applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8637libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8638
8639@example
8640bin/
8641 cygxxx.dll
8642lib/
8643 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8644 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8645@end example
8646
c0065db7
RM
8647Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8648done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8649
86501. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8651@example
8652gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8653@end example
2ca22b03 8654
69da35b5
NC
8655However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8656(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8657@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8658not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8659
2ca22b03
NC
86602. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8661directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8662should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8663making the app/dll.
8664
8665@example
8666ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8667@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8668
8669Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8670
8671@example
8672gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8673@end example
69da35b5
NC
8674
8675This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8676perfectly legal
8677
8678@example
8679bin/
8680 cygxxx-5.dll
8681lib/
c0065db7 8682 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8683@end example
8684
dc8465bf 8685Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8686even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8687@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8688
8689Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8690wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8691
86921. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8693work with auto-imported data.
8694
dc8465bf
NC
86952. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8696import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8697symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8698for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8699possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8700
45e948fe
NC
87013. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8702critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8703in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8704stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8705
69da35b5 8706So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8707true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8708a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8709binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8710massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8711requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8712will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8713
c0065db7 8714@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8715@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8716@item adding additional names
8717Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8718A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8719exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8720when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8721import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8722
c0065db7 8723@example
dc8465bf
NC
8724LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8725
8726EXPORTS
c0065db7 8727foo
dc8465bf 8728_foo = foo
c0065db7 8729@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8730
8731The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8732
8733Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8734source code using the "weak" attribute:
8735
c0065db7
RM
8736@example
8737void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8738void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8739@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8740
8741See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8742symbols.
8743
8744@item renaming symbols
8745Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8746kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8747@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8748DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8749created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8750
c0065db7 8751@example
dc8465bf
NC
8752LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8753
8754EXPORTS
8755_foo = foo
c0065db7 8756@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8757
8758The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8759@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8760@end table
dc8465bf 8761
0a5d968e 8762Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8763unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8764If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8765@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8766that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8767@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8768renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8769to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8770the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8771In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8772which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8773
8774@cindex weak externals
8775@item weak externals
8776The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8777weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8778defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8779are three variants of weak externals:
8780@itemize
8781@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8782called lazy externals.
8783@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8784This form is not presently implemented.
8785@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8786implemented.
8787@end itemize
8788As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8789are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8790uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8791
8792@cindex aligned common symbols
8793@item aligned common symbols
8794As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8795desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8796the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8797carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8798by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8799tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8800but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8801warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8802
2ca22b03
NC
8803@end table
8804
8805@ifclear GENERIC
8806@lowersections
8807@end ifclear
8808@end ifset
8809
e0001a05
NC
8810@ifset XTENSA
8811@ifclear GENERIC
8812@raisesections
8813@end ifclear
8814
8815@node Xtensa
8816@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8817
8818@cindex Xtensa processors
8819The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8820@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8821specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8822keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8823example, with the command:
8824
8825@smallexample
8826SECTIONS
8827@{
8828 .text : @{
8829 *(.literal .text)
8830 @}
8831@}
8832@end smallexample
8833
8834@noindent
8835@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8836and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8837literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8838interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8839group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8840files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8841and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8842
43cd72b9 8843@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8844@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8845Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8846provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8847is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8848literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8849will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8850location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8851the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8852unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8853@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8854range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8855
8856For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8857to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8858instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8859instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8860instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8861@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8862hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8863By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8864switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8865density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8866instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8867performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8868linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8869a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8870
8871The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8872control the linker:
8873
8874@cindex Xtensa options
8875@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8876@item --size-opt
8877When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8878more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8879no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8880alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8881preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8882
8883@item --abi-windowed
8884@itemx --abi-call0
8885Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8886PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8887because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8888conventions.
8889Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8890of the first input object.
8891A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8892or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8893@end table
e0001a05
NC
8894
8895@ifclear GENERIC
8896@lowersections
8897@end ifclear
8898@end ifset
8899
252b5132
RH
8900@ifclear SingleFormat
8901@node BFD
8902@chapter BFD
8903
8904@cindex back end
8905@cindex object file management
8906@cindex object formats available
8907@kindex objdump -i
8908The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8909These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8910object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8911format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8912it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8913associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8914object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8915(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8916list all the formats available for your configuration.
8917
8918@cindex BFD requirements
8919@cindex requirements for BFD
8920As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8921several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8922BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8923formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8924been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8925BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8926may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8927
8928One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8929mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8930useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8931conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8932
8933@menu
8934* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8935@end menu
8936
8937@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8938@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8939@cindex opening object files
8940@include bfdsumm.texi
8941@end ifclear
8942
8943@node Reporting Bugs
8944@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8945@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8946@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8947
ff5dcc92 8948Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8949
8950Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8951it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8952to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8953work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8954@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8955
8956In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8957information that enables us to fix the bug.
8958
8959@menu
8960* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8961* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8962@end menu
8963
8964@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8965@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8966@cindex bug criteria
8967
8968If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8969
8970@itemize @bullet
8971@cindex fatal signal
8972@cindex linker crash
8973@cindex crash of linker
8974@item
8975If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8976@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8977
8978@cindex error on valid input
8979@item
ff5dcc92 8980If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8981
8982@cindex invalid input
8983@item
ff5dcc92 8984If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8985may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8986object files are correct.
8987
8988@item
8989If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8990improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8991@end itemize
8992
8993@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8994@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8995@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8996@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8997
8998A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8999products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9000recommend you contact that organization first.
9001
9002You can find contact information for many support companies and
9003individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9004distribution.
9005
ad22bfe8 9006@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9007Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9008@value{BUGURL}.
9009@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9010
9011The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9012@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9013fact or leave it out, state it!
9014
9015Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9016problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9017assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9018matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9019the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9020location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9021were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9022into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9023specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9024and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9025
9026Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9027the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9028on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9029
9030Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9031bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9032respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9033You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9034
9035To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9036
9037@itemize @bullet
9038@item
ff5dcc92 9039The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9040the @samp{--version} argument.
9041
9042Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9043the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9044
9045@item
ff5dcc92 9046Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9047patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9048
9049@item
9050The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9051version number.
9052
9053@item
ff5dcc92 9054What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9055``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9056
9057@item
9058The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9059observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9060list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9061sufficient.
9062
9063If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9064and then we might not encounter the bug.
9065
9066@item
9067A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9068bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9069provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9070bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9071state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9072requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9073we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9074attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9075
9076If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9077@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9078object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9079@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9080how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9081
9082@item
9083A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9084incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9085
ff5dcc92 9086Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9087will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9088not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9089a chance to make a mistake.
9090
9091Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9092say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9093copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9094C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9095and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9096fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9097you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9098any conclusion from our observations.
9099
9100@item
ff5dcc92 9101If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9102diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9103@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9104If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9105context, not by line number.
9106
9107The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9108sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9109@end itemize
9110
9111Here are some things that are not necessary:
9112
9113@itemize @bullet
9114@item
9115A description of the envelope of the bug.
9116
9117Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9118which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9119changes will not affect it.
9120
9121This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9122will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9123with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9124We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9125
9126Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9127of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9128output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9129less time, and so on.
9130
9131However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9132report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9133
9134@item
9135A patch for the bug.
9136
9137A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9138the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9139a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9140to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9141
ff5dcc92 9142Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9143construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9144through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9145able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9146fixed.
9147
9148And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9149patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9150help us to understand.
9151
9152@item
9153A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9154
9155Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9156things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9157@end itemize
9158
9159@node MRI
9160@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9161@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9162To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9163linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9164alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9165described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9166simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9167@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9168linker commands; these commands are described here.
9169
9170In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9171file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9172features to make use of them.
9173
9174You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9175@samp{-c} command-line option.
9176
9177Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9178command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9179blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9180MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9181issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9182
9183Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9184
9185You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9186lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9187The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9188
9189@table @code
9190@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9191@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9192@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9193Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9194the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9195@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9196your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9197script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9198commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9199input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9200@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9201
9202@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9203@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9204Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9205in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9206
9207@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9208
9209@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9210@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9211Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9212@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9213
9214@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9215@item BASE @var{expression}
9216Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9217absolute addresses) in the output file.
9218
9219@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9220@item CHIP @var{expression}
9221@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9222This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9223
9224@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9225@item END
9226This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9227
9228@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9229@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9230Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9231language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9232
9233@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9234@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9235Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9236@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9237
9238The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9239same line, with no change in its effect.
9240
9241@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9242@item LOAD @var{filename}
9243@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9244Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9245same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9246command line.
9247
9248@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9249@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9250@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9251MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9252option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9253
9254@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9255@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9256@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9257Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9258order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9259script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9260sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9261file, in the order specified.
9262
9263@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9264@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9265@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9266@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9267Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9268@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9269
9270@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9271@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9272@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9273@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9274You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9275specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9276If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9277@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9278@end table
9279
793c5807
NC
9280@node GNU Free Documentation License
9281@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9282@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9283
370b66a1
CD
9284@node LD Index
9285@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9286
9287@printindex cp
9288
9289@tex
7ca01ed9 9290% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9291% meantime:
9292\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9293\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9294\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9295\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9296\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9297\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9298\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9299\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9300\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9301% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9302@end tex
9303
252b5132 9304@bye
This page took 2.721756 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.